US20170112851A1 - Hexahydrodiazepinoquinolines carrying a substituted alkyl radical - Google Patents
Hexahydrodiazepinoquinolines carrying a substituted alkyl radical Download PDFInfo
- Publication number
- US20170112851A1 US20170112851A1 US15/397,902 US201715397902A US2017112851A1 US 20170112851 A1 US20170112851 A1 US 20170112851A1 US 201715397902 A US201715397902 A US 201715397902A US 2017112851 A1 US2017112851 A1 US 2017112851A1
- Authority
- US
- United States
- Prior art keywords
- fluorinated
- alkyl
- alkoxy
- disorders
- group
- Prior art date
- Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
- Abandoned
Links
- 0 *C1(*)C2=CC=CC3=C2N(CCN1[1*])C(*)(*)C(*)(*)C3[6*].CC.CC Chemical compound *C1(*)C2=CC=CC3=C2N(CCN1[1*])C(*)(*)C(*)(*)C3[6*].CC.CC 0.000 description 18
Classifications
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61K—PREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
- A61K31/00—Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
- A61K31/33—Heterocyclic compounds
- A61K31/395—Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
- A61K31/55—Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having seven-membered rings, e.g. azelastine, pentylenetetrazole
- A61K31/551—Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having seven-membered rings, e.g. azelastine, pentylenetetrazole having two nitrogen atoms, e.g. dilazep
- A61K31/5513—1,4-Benzodiazepines, e.g. diazepam or clozapine
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61P—SPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
- A61P25/00—Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07D—HETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
- C07D471/00—Heterocyclic compounds containing nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms in the condensed system, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with one nitrogen atom, not provided for by groups C07D451/00 - C07D463/00
- C07D471/02—Heterocyclic compounds containing nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms in the condensed system, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with one nitrogen atom, not provided for by groups C07D451/00 - C07D463/00 in which the condensed system contains two hetero rings
- C07D471/04—Ortho-condensed systems
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C07—ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
- C07D—HETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
- C07D471/00—Heterocyclic compounds containing nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms in the condensed system, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with one nitrogen atom, not provided for by groups C07D451/00 - C07D463/00
- C07D471/12—Heterocyclic compounds containing nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms in the condensed system, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with one nitrogen atom, not provided for by groups C07D451/00 - C07D463/00 in which the condensed system contains three hetero rings
- C07D471/18—Bridged systems
Definitions
- the present invention relates to tricyclic hexahydrodiazepinoquinolines carrying a substituted alkyl radical, to a method for producing them, to a pharmaceutical composition containing such compounds, to their use as modulators, especially agonists or partial agonists, of the 5-HT 2C receptor, their use for preparing a medicament for the prevention or treatment of conditions and disorders which respond to the modulation of 5-HT 2C receptor, to a method for preventing or treating conditions and disorders which respond to the modulation of 5-HT 2C receptor, and processes for preparing such compounds and compositions.
- 5-HT 2C modulation is desired are for example depression, anxiety, schizophrenia, bipolar disorder, obsessive compulsive disorder, migraine, pain, epilepsy, substance abuse, eating disorders, obesity, diabetes, erectile dysfunction and others.
- Serotonin (5-hydroxytryptamine, 5-HT), a monoamine neurotransmitter and local hormone, is formed by the hydroxylation and decarboxylation of tryptophan. The greatest concentration is found in the enterochromaffin cells of the gastrointestinal tract, the remainder being predominantly present in platelets and in the Central Nervous System (CNS).
- 5-HT is implicated in a vast array of physiological and pathophysiological pathways. In the periphery, it contracts a number of smooth muscles and induces endothelium-dependent vasodilation. In the CNS, it is believed to be involved in a wide range of functions, including the control of appetite, mood, anxiety, hallucinations, sleep, vomiting and pain perception.
- 5-HT 1 Neurons that secrete 5-HT are termed serotonergic.
- 5-HT 1B Neurons that secrete 5-HT is exerted upon its interaction with specific (serotonergic) neurons.
- 5-HT 2 with subtypes 5-HT 2A , 5-HT 2B and 5-HT 2C
- 5-HT 3 5-HT 4
- 5-HT 5 with subtypes 5-HT 5A and 5-HT 5B
- 5-HT 6 and 5-HT 7 are coupled to G-proteins that affect the activities of adenylate cyclase or phospholipase C ⁇ .
- the schizophrenic symptomatology is further complicated by the occurrence of drug-induced so-called secondary negative symptoms and cognitive impairment, which are difficult to distinguish from primary negative and cognitive symptoms [Remington G and Kapur S (2000). Atypical antipsychotics: are some more atypical than others? Psychopharmacol 148: 3-15].
- the occurrence of secondary negative symptoms not only limits therapeutic efficacy but also, together with these side effects, negatively affects patient compliance.
- the 5-HT 2C receptor is a G-protein-coupled receptor, which couples to multiple cellular effector systems including the phospholipase C, A and D pathways. It is found primarily in the brain and its distribution is particularly high in the plexus choroideus, where it is assumed to control cerebrospinal fluid production [Kaufman M J, Hirata F (1996) Cyclic GMP inhibits phosphoinositide turnover in choroid plexus: evidence for interactions between second messengers concurrently triggered by 5-HT 2C receptors. Neurosci Lett 206:153-156].
- modulation of the 5-HT 2C receptor will improve disorders such as depression, anxiety, schizophrenia, cognitive deficits of schizophrenia, obsessive compulsive disorder, bipolar disorder, neuropsychiatric symptoms in Parkinson' disease, in Alzheimer's disease or Lewy Body dementia, migraine, epilepsy, substance abuse, eating disorders, obesity, diabetes, sexual dysfunction/erectile dysfunction, sleep disorders, psoriasis, Parkinson's disease, pain conditions and disorders, and spinal cord injury, smoking cessation, ocular hypertension and Alzheimer's disease.
- Modulators of the 5-HT 2C receptor are also shown to be useful in the modulation of bladder function, including the prevention or treatment of urinary incontinence.
- the compounds should have low affinity to adrenergic receptors, such as the ⁇ 1 -adrenergic receptor, histamine receptors, such as the H 1 -receptor, and dopaminergic receptors, such as the D 2 -receptor, in order to avoid or reduce side effects associated with modulation of these receptors, such as postural hypotension, reflex tachycardia, potentiation of the antihypertensive effect of prazosin, terazosin, doxazosin and labetalol or dizziness associated with the blockade of the ⁇ 1 -adrenergic receptor, weight gain, sedation, drowsiness or potentiation of central depressant drugs associated with the blockade of the H 1 -receptor, or extrapyramidal movement disorder, such as dystonia, parkinsonism, akathisia, tardive dys
- the compounds have low affinity or alternatively an antagonistic effect to/on other serotonergic receptors, especially the 5-HT 2A and/or 5-HT 2B receptors, in order to avoid or reduce side effects associated with modulation of these receptors, such as changes (thickening) of the heart tissue associated with agonism at the 5-HT 2B receptor, and psychotomimetic effect induced by agonism at the 5-HT 2A receptor.
- they should show an agonistic action on the 5-HT 2C receptor, an antagonistic action on the 5-HT 2A receptor or alternatively no affinity to the 5-HT 2A receptor and no affinity to the 5-HT 2B receptor or alternatively an antagonistic action on the 5-HT 2B receptor.
- the compounds should display an agonistic action on the 5-HT 2C receptor in combination with an antagonistic action on the 5-HT 2A receptor and no affinity to the 5-HT 2B receptor.
- 5-HT 2C -related disorders such as, for example:
- the metabolic stability for example determined from the half-lives, measured in vitro, in liver microsomes from various species (e.g. rat or human);
- cytochrome P450 is the name for a superfamily of heme proteins having enzymatic activity (oxidase). They are also particularly important for the degradation (metabolism) of foreign substances such as drugs or xenobiotics in mammalian organisms.
- the principal representatives of the types and subtypes of CYP in the human body are: CYP 1A2, CYP 2C9, CYP 2D6 and CYP 3A4. If CYP 3A4 inhibitors (e.g.
- grapefruit juice, cimetidine, erythromycin are used at the same time as medicinal substances which are degraded by this enzyme system and thus compete for the same binding site on the enzyme, the degradation thereof may be slowed down and thus effects and side effects of the administered medicinal substance may be undesirably enhanced;
- suitable pharmacokinetics time course of the concentration of the compound of the invention in plasma or in tissue, for example brain.
- the pharmacokinetics can be described by the following parameters: half-life (in h), volume of distribution (in 1 ⁇ kg ⁇ 1), plasma clearance (in 1 ⁇ h ⁇ 1 ⁇ kg ⁇ 1), AUC (area under the curve, area under the concentration-time curve, in ng ⁇ h ⁇ 1 ⁇ 1), oral bioavailability (the dose-normalized ratio of AUC after oral administration and AUC after intravenous administration), the so-called brain-plasma ratio (the ratio of AUC in brain tissue and AUC in plasma);
- no or only low blockade of the hERG channel compounds which block the hERG channel may cause a prolongation of the QT interval and thus lead to serious disturbances of cardiac rhythm (for example so-called “torsade de pointes”).
- the potential of compounds to block the hERG channel can be determined by means of the displacement assay with radiolabelled dofetilide which is described in the literature (G. J. Diaz et al., Journal of Pharmacological and Toxicological Methods, 50 (2004), 187 199).
- a smaller IC50 in this dofetilide assay means a greater probability of potent hERG blockade.
- the blockade of the hERG channel can be measured by electrophysiological experiments on cells which have been transfected with the hERG channel, by so-called whole-cell patch clamping (G. J. Diaz et al., Journal of Pharmacological and Toxicological Methods, 50 (2004), 187-199).
- the compounds were intended to have a high affinity on the 5-HT 2C receptor and be potent and efficacious 5-HT 2C agonists.
- the compounds of the invention were intended to have one or more of the aforementioned advantages, namely low affinity to other serotonergic receptors, and especially the lack of potent agonistic effect (antagonism preferred) on the 5-HT 2A and/or 5-HT 2B receptors, and additionally one or more of those advantages mentioned under 1.) to 5.).
- the present invention provides compounds which have an affinity for the 5-HT 2C , thus allowing the treatment of disorders related to or affected by the 5-HT 2C receptor.
- the present invention relates to tricyclic hexahydrodiazepinoquinolines carrying a substituted alkyl radical, to a method for producing them, to compositions comprising such compounds, their use as modulators, especially agonists or partial agonists, of the 5-HT 2C receptor, their use for preparing a medicament for the prevention or treatment of conditions and disorders which respond to the modulation of 5-HT 2C receptor, to a method for preventing or treating conditions and disorders which respond to the modulation of 5-HT 2C receptor, and processes for preparing such compounds and compositions.
- the present invention relates to compounds of the formula (I):
- the invention in another aspect, relates to a pharmaceutical composition
- a pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount of at least one compound of formula I or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, in combination with at least one pharmaceutically acceptable carrier and/or auxiliary substance.
- the invention relates to a compound of formula I or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof for use as a medicament.
- the invention relates to a compound of formula I or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof for the treatment of disorders which responds to the modulation of the 5-HT 2C receptor.
- the invention relates to the use of a compound of formula I or of an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof for the manufacture of a medicament for the treatment of disorders which respond to the modulation of the 5-HT 2C receptor.
- the invention relates to the use of a compound of formula I or of an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof for the manufacture of a medicament for the treatment of disorders selected from the group consisting of damage of the central nervous system, disorders of the central nervous system, eating disorders, ocular hypertension, cardiovascular disorders, gastrointestinal disorders and diabetes, and especially from the group consisting of bipolar disorder, depression, atypical depression, mood episodes, adjustment disorders, anxiety, panic disorders, post-traumatic syndrome, psychoses, schizophrenia, cognitive deficits of schizophrenia, memory loss, dementia of aging, Alzheimer's disease, neuropsychiatric symptoms in Alzheimer's disease (e.g.
- Parkinson's disease neuropsychiatric symptoms in Parkinson's disease (e.g.
- Lewy Body dementia neuropsychiatric symptoms in Lewy Body dementia (e.g. aggression), spinal cord injury, trauma, stroke, pain, bladder dysfunction/urinary incontinence, encephalitis, meningitis, eating disorders, obesity, bulimia, weight loss, anorexia nervosa, ocular hypertension, cardiovascular disorders, gastrointestinal disorders, diabetes insipidus, diabetes mellitus, type I diabetes, type II diabetes, type III diabetes, diabetes secondary to pancreatic diseases, diabetes related to steroid use, diabetes complications, hyperglycemia and insulin resistance.
- Lewy Body dementia neuropsychiatric symptoms in Lewy Body dementia (e.g. aggression)
- spinal cord injury trauma, stroke, pain, bladder dysfunction/urinary incontinence, encephalitis, meningitis, eating disorders, obesity, bulimia, weight loss, anorexia nervosa
- ocular hypertension cardiovascular disorders, gastrointestinal disorders, diabetes insipidus, diabetes mellitus, type I diabetes
- the invention relates to a method for treating disorders which respond to the modulation of the 5-HT 2C receptor, which method comprises administering to a subject in need thereof at least one compound of formula I or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
- the invention relates to a method for treating disorders selected from the group consisting of damage of the central nervous system, disorders of the central nervous system, eating disorders, ocular hypertension, cardiovascular disorders, gastrointestinal disorders and diabetes, and especially from the group consisting of bipolar disorder, depression, atypical depression, mood episodes, adjustment disorders, anxiety, panic disorders, post-traumatic syndrome, psychoses, schizophrenia, cognitive deficits of schizophrenia, memory loss, dementia of aging, Alzheimer's disease, neuropsychiatric symptoms in Alzheimer's disease (e.g.
- Parkinson's disease neuropsychiatric symptoms in Parkinson's disease (e.g.
- Lewy Body dementia neuropsychiatric symptoms in Lewy Body dementia (e.g. aggression), spinal cord injury, trauma, stroke, pain, bladder dysfunction/urinary incontinence, encephalitis, meningitis, eating disorders, obesity, bulimia, weight loss, anorexia nervosa, ocular hypertension, cardiovascular disorders, gastrointestinal disorders, diabetes insipidus, diabetes mellitus, type I diabetes, type II diabetes, type III diabetes, diabetes secondary to pancreatic diseases, diabetes related to steroid use, diabetes complications, hyperglycemia and insulin resistance, which method comprises administering to a subject in need thereof at least one compound of formula I or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
- the compounds of the formula I may exist in different spatial arrangements.
- the present invention contemplates the possible use of enantiomeric mixtures, in particular racemates, diastereomeric mixtures and tautomeric mixtures, such as the respective essentially pure enantiomers, diastereomers and tautomers of the compounds of formula I and/or their salts.
- physiologically tolerated salts of the compounds of the formula I especially acid addition salts with physiologically tolerated acids.
- suitable physiologically tolerated organic and inorganic acids are hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, phosphoric acid, sulfuric acid, acetic acid, trifluoroacetic acid, C 1 -C 4 -alkylsulfonic acids, such as methanesulfonic acid, aromatic sulfonic acids, such as benzenesulfonic acid and toluenesulfonic acid, oxalic acid, maleic acid, fumaric acid, lactic acid, tartaric acid, adipic acid and benzoic acid.
- Other utilizable acids are described in Fort Whitneye der Arzneiffenbachforschung [Advances in drug research], Volume 10, pages 224 et seq., Birkhäuser Verlag, Basel and Stuttgart, 1966.
- the compounds of formula I may also be present in the form of tautomers.
- tautomery may be present in compounds I wherein R 4a and R 4b form together a group ⁇ O and R 5a or R 5b is H.
- the compounds of formula I may have the following tautomeric formulae:
- tautomery may be present in compounds I containing rings which have one or more C ⁇ O groups as ring members which are neighboured to a CH 2 group.
- organic moieties mentioned in the above definitions of the variables are, like the term halogen, collective terms for individual listings of the individual group members.
- the prefix C n -C m indicates in each case the possible number of carbon atoms in the group.
- halogen denotes in each case fluorine, bromine, chlorine or iodine. In one aspect, the halogen may be fluorine, chlorine or bromine.
- alkyl as used herein and in the alkyl moieties of alkoxy, alkylthio, alkylsulfinyl, alkylsulfonyl, alkylcarbonyl, alkoxycarbonyl and the like refers to saturated straight-chain or branched hydrocarbon radicals having 1 to 2 (“C 1 -C 2 -alkyl”), 1 to 3 (“C 1 -C 3 -alkyl”), 1 to 4 (“C 1 -C 4 -alkyl”) or 1 to 6 (“C 1 -C 6 -alkyl”) carbon atoms.
- C 1 -C 2 -Alkyl is methyl or ethyl.
- C 1 -C 3 -Alkyl is additionally propyl and isopropyl.
- C 1 -C 4 -Alkyl is additionally butyl, 1-methylpropyl (sec-butyl), 2-methylpropyl (isobutyl) or 1,1-dimethylethyl (tert-butyl).
- C 1 -C 6 -Alkyl is additionally also, for example, pentyl, 1-methylbutyl, 2-methylbutyl, 3-methylbutyl, 2,2-dimethylpropyl, 1-ethylpropyl, 1,1-dimethylpropyl, 1,2-dimethylpropyl, hexyl, 1-methylpentyl, 2-methylpentyl, 3-methylpentyl, 4-methylpentyl, 1,1-dimethylbutyl, 1,2-dimethylbutyl, 1,3-dimethylbutyl, 2,2-dimethylbutyl, 2,3-dimethylbutyl, 3,3-dimethylbutyl, 1-ethylbutyl, 2-ethylbutyl, 1,1,2-trimethylpropyl, 1,2,2-trimethylpropyl, 1-ethyl-1-methylpropyl, or 1-ethyl-2-methylpropyl.
- fluorinated alkyl refers to straight-chain or branched alkyl groups having 1 (“fluorinated methyl), 1 to 2 (“fluorinated C 1 -C 2 -alkyl”), 1 to 3 (“fluorinated C 1 -C 3 -alkyl”), 1 to 4 (“fluorinated C 1 -C 4 -alkyl”) or 1 to 6 (“fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkyl”) carbon atoms (as mentioned above), where some or all of the hydrogen atoms in these groups are replaced by fluorine atoms.
- Fluorinated methyl is fluoromethyl, difluoromethyl or trifluoromethyl.
- Fluorinated C 1 -C 2 -alkyl is an alkyl group having 1 or 2 carbon atoms (as mentioned above), where at least one of the hydrogen atoms, e.g. 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5 hydrogen atoms in these groups are replaced by fluorine atoms, such as difluoromethyl, trifluoromethyl, 1-fluoroethyl, (R)-1-fluoroethyl, (S)-1-fluoroethyl, 2-fluoroethyl, 2,2-difluoroethyl, 2,2,2-trifluoroethyl, or pentafluoroethyl.
- fluorine atoms such as difluoromethyl, trifluoromethyl, 1-fluoroethyl, (R)-1-fluoroethyl, (S)-1-fluoroethyl, 2-fluoroethyl, 2,2-difluoroethyl, 2,2,2-trifluoroe
- Fluorinated C 1 -C 4 -alkyl is a straight-chain or branched alkyl group having 1 to 4 carbon atoms (as mentioned above), where at least one of the hydrogen atoms, e.g. 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5 hydrogen atoms in these groups are replaced by fluorine atoms.
- Examples are, apart those listed above for C 1 -C 2 -fluoroalkyl, 1-fluoropropyl, (R)-1-fluoropropyl, (S)-1-fluoropropyl, 2-fluoropropyl, (R)-2-fluoropropyl, (S)-2-fluoropropyl, 3-fluoropropyl, 1,1-difluoropropyl, 2,2-difluoropropyl, 1,2-difluoropropyl, 2,3-difluoropropyl, 1,3-difluoropropyl, 3,3-difluoropropyl, 1,1,2-trifluoropropyl, 1,2,2-trifluoropropyl, 1,2,3-trifluoropropyl, 2,2,3-trifluoropropyl, 3,3,3-trifluoropropyl, 1,1,1-trifluoroprop-2-yl, 2-fluoro-1-methylethyl, (R)-2-
- Fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkyl is a straight-chain or branched alkyl group having 1 to 6 carbon atoms (as mentioned above), where at least one of the hydrogen atoms, e.g. 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5 hydrogen atoms in these groups are replaced by fluorine atoms.
- C 1 -C 4 -fluoroalkyl 1-fluoropentyl, (R)-1-fluoropentyl, (S)-1-fluoropentyl, 2-fluoropentyl, (R)-2-fluoropentyl, (S)-2-fluoropentyl, 3-fluoropentyl, (R)-3-fluoropentyl, (S)-3-fluoropentyl, 4-fluoropentyl, (R)-4-fluoropentyl, (S)-4-fluoropentyl, 5-fluoropentyl, (R)-5-fluoropentyl, (S)-5-fluoropentyl, 1-fluorohexyl, (R)-1-fluorohexyl, (S)-1-fluorohexyl, 2-fluorohexyl, (R)-2-fluorohexyl, (S)-2-fluorohexyl, 3-fluorohex
- haloalkyl refers to straight-chain or branched alkyl groups having 1 to 2 (“C 1 -C 2 -haloalkyl”), 1 to 3 (“C 1 -C 3 -haloalkyl”), 1 to 4 (“C 1 -C 4 -haloalkyl”) or 1 to 6 (“C 1 -C 6 -haloalkyl”) carbon atoms (as mentioned above), where some or all of the hydrogen atoms in these groups are replaced by halogen atoms as mentioned above.
- Examples are, apart from those mentioned above for fluorinated alkyl, for C 1 -C 2 -haloalkyl chloromethyl, bromomethyl, dichloromethyl, trichloromethyl, chlorofluoromethyl, dichlorofluoromethyl, chlorodifluoromethyl, 1-chloroethyl, 1-bromoethyl, 2-chloro-2-fluoroethyl, 2-chloro-2,2-difluoroethyl, 2,2-dichloro-2-fluoroethyl or 2,2,2-trichloroethyl; for C 1 -C 3 -haloalkyl, apart those mentioned for C 1 -C 2 -haloalkyl, 3-chloropropyl; and for C 1 -C 4 -haloalkyl, apart those mentioned for C 1 -C 3 -haloalkyl, 4-chlorobutyl and the like.
- alkenyl refers to monounsaturated straight-chain or branched hydrocarbon radicals having 2 to 3 (“C 2 -C 3 -alkenyl”), 2 to 4 (“C 2 -C 4 -alkenyl”) or 2 to 6 (“C 2 -C 6 -alkenyl”) carbon atoms and a double bond in any position, such as C 2 -C 3 -alkenyl, such as ethenyl, 1-propenyl, 2-propenyl or 1-methylethenyl; C 2 -C 4 -alkenyl, such as ethenyl, 1-propenyl, 2-propenyl, 1-methylethenyl, 1-butenyl, 2-butenyl, 3-butenyl, 1-methyl -1-propenyl, 2-methyl -1-propenyl, 1-methyl-2-propenyl or 2-methyl-2-propenyl; and C 2 -C 6 -alkenyl, such
- fluorinated alkenyl refers to unsaturated straight-chain or branched hydrocarbon radicals having 2 to 3 (“fluorinated C 2 -C 3 -alkenyl”), 2 to 4 (“fluorinated C 2 -C 4 -alkenyl”) or 2 to 6 (“fluorinated C 2 -C 6 -alkenyl”) carbon atoms and a double bond in any position (as mentioned above), where some or all of the hydrogen atoms in these groups are replaced by fluorine atoms, such as, fluorovinyl, fluoroallyl and the like.
- alkynyl refers to straight-chain or branched hydrocarbon groups having 2 to 3 (“C 2 -C 3 -alkynyl”), 2 to 4 (“C 2 -C 4 -alkynyl”) or 2 to 6 (“C 2 -C 6 -alkynyl”) carbon atoms and one or two triple bonds in any position, such as C 2 -C 3 -alkynyl, such as ethynyl, 1-propynyl or 2-propynyl; C 2 -C 4 -alkynyl, such as ethynyl, 1-propynyl, 2-propynyl, 1-butynyl, 2-butynyl, 3-butynyl, 1-methyl-2-propynyl and the like, and C 2 -C 6 -alkynyl, such as ethynyl, 1-propynyl, 2-propynyl, 1-butynyl,
- fluorinated alkynyl refers to unsaturated straight-chain or branched hydrocarbon radicals having 2 to 3 (“fluorinated C 2 -C 3 -alkynyl”), 3 to 4 (“fluorinated C 3 -C 4 -alkynyl”) or 2 to 6 (“fluorinated C 2 -C 6 -alkynyl”) carbon atoms and one or two triple bonds in any position (as mentioned above), where some or all of the hydrogen atoms in these groups are replaced by fluorine atoms.
- cycloalkyl refers to monocyclic saturated hydrocarbon radicals having 3 to 8 (“C 3 -C 8 -cycloalkyl”), in particular 3 to 6 carbon atoms (“C 3 -C 6 -cycloalkyl”) or 3 to 5 carbon atoms (“C 3 -C 5 -cycloalkyl”) or 3 or 4 carbon atoms (“C 3 -C 4 -cycloalkyl”).
- C 3 -C 4 -cycloalkyl are cyclopropyl and cyclobutyl.
- Examples of C 3 -C 5 -cycloalkyl are cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl and cyclopentyl.
- C 3 -C 6 -cycloalkyl examples are cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl and cyclohexyl.
- Examples of C 3 -C 8 -cycloalkyl are cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, cycloheptyl and cyclooctyl.
- fluorinated cycloalkyl refers to monocyclic saturated hydrocarbon groups having 3 to 8 (“C 3 -C 8 -halocycloalkyl”) or preferably 3 to 6 (“C 3 -C 6 -halocycloalkyl”) or 3 to 5 (“C 3 -C 5 -halocycloalkyl”) carbon ring members (as mentioned above) in which some or all of the hydrogen atoms are replaced by fluorine atoms.
- Examples include 1-fluorocyclopropyl, 2-fluorocyclopropyl, (S)- and (R)-2,2-difluorocyclopropyl, 1,2-difluorocyclopropyl, 2,3-difluorocyclopropyl, pentafluorocyclopropyl, 1-fluorocyclobutyl, 2-fluorocyclobutyl, 3-fluorocyclobutyl, 2,2-difluorocyclobutyl, 3,3-difluorocyclobutyl, 1,2-difluorocyclobutyl, 1,3-difluorocyclobutyl, 2,3-difluorocyclobutyl, 2,4-difluorocyclobutyl, 1,2,2-trifluorocyclobutyl, 1-fluorocycloheptyl, 2-fluorocycloheptyl, 3-fluorocycloheptyl, 4-fluorocycloheptyl, 1,2-
- cycloalkenyl refers to monocyclic partially unsaturated, non-aromatic hydrocarbon radicals having 3 to 8 (“C 3 -C 8 -cycloalkenyl”), in particular 5 to 7 carbon atoms (“C 5 -C 7 -cycloalkenyl”) or 5 or 6 carbon atoms (“C 5 -C 6 -cycloalkenyl”) and one or more non-cumulative, preferably one, C—C double bonds in the ring.
- C 5 -C 6 -cycloalkenyl examples include cyclopent-1-en-1-yl, cyclopent-1-en-3-yl, cyclopent-1-en-4-yl, cyclopenta-1,3-dien-1-yl, cyclopenta-1,3-dien-2-yl, cyclopenta-1,3-dien-5-yl, cyclohex-1-en-1-yl, cyclohex-1-en-3-yl, cyclohex-1-en-4-yl, cyclohexa-1,3-dien-1-yl, cyclohexa-1,3-dien-2-yl, cyclohexa-1,3-dien-5-yl, cyclohexa-1,4-dien-1-yl and cyclohexa-1,4-dien-3-yl.
- C 5 -C 7 -cycloalkenyl are, apart those mentioned above, include for C 5 -C 6 -cycloalkenyl, cyclohept-1-en-1-yl, cyclohept-1-en-3-yl, cyclohept-1-en-4-yl, cyclohept-1-en-5-yl, cyclohepta-1,3-dien-1-yl, cyclohepta-1,3-dien-2-yl, cyclohepta-1,3-dien-5-yl, cyclohepta-1,3-dien-6-yl, cyclohepta-1,4-dien-1-yl, cyclohepta-1,4-dien-2-yl, cyclohepta-1,4-dien-3-yl and cyclohepta-1,4-dien-6-yl.
- C 3 -C 8 -cycloalkenyl are, apart those mentioned above for C 5 -C 6 -cycloalkenyl, cycloprop-1-en-1-yl, cycloprop-1-en-3-yl, cyclobut-1-en-1-yl, cyclobut-1-en-3-yl, cyclooct-1-en-1-yl, cyclooct-1-en-3-yl, cyclooct-1-en-4-yl, cyclooct-1-en-5-yl, cycloocta-1,3-dien-1-yl, cycloocta-1,3-dien-2-yl, cycloocta-1,3-dien-5-yl, cycloocta-1,3-dien-6-yl, cycloocta-1,4-dien-1-yl, cycloocta-1,4-dien-2-yl, cyclooct
- fluorinated cycloalkenyl refers to monocyclic partially unsaturated, non-aromatic hydrocarbon radicals having 3 to 8 (“fluorinated C 3 -C 8 -cycloalkenyl”), in particular 5 to 7 carbon atoms (“fluorinated C 5 -C 7 -cycloalkenyl”) or 5 or 6 carbon atoms (“fluorinated C 5 -C 6 -cycloalkenyl”) and one or more non-cumulative, preferably one, C—C double bonds in the ring and in which some or all of the hydrogen atoms are replaced by fluorine atoms.
- cycloalkyl-C 1 -C 4 -alkyl refers to a C 3 -C 8 -cycloalkyl group (“C 3 -C 8 -cycloalkyl-C 1 -C 4 -alkyl”), preferably a C 3 -C 6 -cycloalkyl group (“C 3 -C 6 -cycloalkyl-C 1 -C 4 -alkyl”) as defined above which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a C 1 -C 4 alkyl group, as defined above.
- cycloalkyl-C 1 -C 2 -alkyl refers to a C 3 -C 8 -cycloalkyl group (“C 3 -C 8 -cycloalkyl-C 1 -C 2 -alkyl”), preferably a C 3 -C 6 -cycloalkyl group (“C 3 -C 6 -cycloalkyl-C 1 -C 2 -alkyl”) as defined above which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a C 1 -C 2 -alkyl group, as defined above.
- C 3 -C 6 -cycloalkyl-C 1 -C 2 -alkyl are cyclopropylmethyl, cyclopropylethyl, cyclobutylmethyl, cyclobutylethyl, cyclopentylmethyl, cyclopentylethyl, cyclohexylmethyl and cyclohexylethyl.
- C 3 -C 6 -cycloalkyl-C 1 -C 4 -alkyl apart those mentioned for C 3 -C 6 -cycloalkyl-C 1 -C 2 -alkyl, are cyclopropylpropyl, cyclopropylbutyl, cyclobutylpropyl, cyclobutylbutyl, cyclopentylpropyl, cyclopentylbutyl, cyclohexylpropyl and cyclohexylbutyl.
- fluorinated cycloalkyl-C 1 -C 4 alkyl refers to a fluorinated C 3 -C 8 -cycloalkyl group (“fluorinated C 3 -C 8 -cycloalkyl-C 1 -C 4 -alkyl”), preferably a fluorinated C 3 -C 6 -cycloalkyl group (“fluorinated C 3 -C 6 -cycloalkyl-C 1 -C 4 -alkyl”) as defined above which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a C 1 -C 4 -alkyl group, as defined above.
- fluorinated cycloalkyl-C 1 -C 2 -alkyl refers to a fluorinated C 3 -C 8 -cycloalkyl group (“fluorinated C 3 -C 8 -cycloalkyl-C 1 -C 2 -alkyl”), preferably a fluorinated C 3 -C 6 -cycloalkyl group (“fluorinated C 3 -C 6 -cycloalkyl-C 1 -C 2 -alkyl”) as defined above which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a C 1 -C 2 -alkyl group, as defined above.
- C 1 -C 2 -alkoxy is a C 1 -C 2 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via an oxygen atom.
- C 1 -C 3 -alkoxy is a C 1 -C 3 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via an oxygen atom.
- C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy is a C 1 -C 4 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via an oxygen atom.
- C 1 -C 6 -alkoxy is a C 1 -C 6 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via an oxygen atom.
- C 1 -C 2 -Alkoxy is methoxy or ethoxy.
- C 1 -C 3 -Alkoxy is additionally, for example, n-propoxy and 1-methylethoxy (isopropoxy).
- C 1 -C 4 -Alkoxy is additionally, for example, butoxy, 1-methylpropoxy (sec-butoxy), 2-methylpropoxy (isobutoxy) or 1,1-dimethylethoxy (tert-butoxy).
- C 1 -C 6 -Alkoxy is additionally, for example, pentoxy, 1-methylbutoxy, 2-methylbutoxy, 3-methylbutoxy, 1,1-dimethylpropoxy, 1,2-dimethylpropoxy, 2,2-dimethylpropoxy, 1-ethylpropoxy, hexoxy, 1-methylpentoxy, 2-methylpentoxy, 3-methylpentoxy, 4-methylpentoxy, 1,1-dimethylbutoxy, 1,2-dimethylbutoxy, 1,3-dimethylbutoxy, 2,2-dimethylbutoxy, 2,3-dimethylbutoxy, 3,3-dimethylbutoxy, 1-ethylbutoxy, 2-ethylbutoxy, 1,1,2-trimethylpropoxy, 1,2,2-trimethylpropoxy, 1-ethyl-1-methylpropoxy or 1-ethyl-2-methylpropoxy.
- C 1 -C 8 -Alkoxy is additionally, for example, heptyloxy, octyloxy, 2-ethylhexyloxy and positional is
- fluorinated C 1 -C 2 -alkoxy is a fluorinated C 1 -C 2 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via an oxygen atom.
- fluorinated C 1 -C 3 -alkoxy is a fluorinated C 1 -C 3 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via an oxygen atom.
- fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -haloalkoxy is a fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via an oxygen atom.
- Fluorinated C 1 -C 2 -alkoxy is, for example, OCH 2 F, OCHF 2 , OCF 3 , 1-fluoroethoxy, (R)-1-fluoroethoxy, (S)-1-fluoroethoxy, 2-fluoroethoxy, 1,1-difluoroethoxy, 1,2-difluoroethoxy, 2,2-difluoroethoxy, 1,1,2-trifluoroethoxy, 1,2,2-trifluoroethoxy, 2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy, 1,1,2,2-tetrafluoroethoxy or OC 2 F 5 .
- Fluorinated C 1 -C 3 -alkoxy is additionally, for example, 1-fluoropropoxy, (R)-1-fluoropropoxy, (S)-1-fluoropropoxy, 2-fluoropropoxy, (R)-2-fluoropropoxy, (S)-2-fluoropropoxy, 3-fluoropropoxy, 1,1-difluoropropoxy, 2,2-difluoropropoxy, 2,3-difluoropropoxy, 3,3-difluoropropoxy, 3,3,3-trifluoropropoxy, (R)-2-fluoro-1-methylethoxy, (S)-2-fluoro-1-methylethoxy, (R)-2,2-difluoro-1-methylethoxy, (S)-2,2-difluoro-1-methylethoxy, (R)-1,2-difluoro-1-methylethoxy, (S)-1,2-difluoro-1-methylethoxy, (R)-1,2-difluoro-1
- Fluorinated C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy is additionally, for example, 1-fluorobutoxy, (R)-1-fluorobutoxy, (S)-1-fluorobutoxy, 2-fluorobutoxy, 3-fluorobutoxy, 4-fluorobutoxy, 1,1-difluorobutoxy, 2,2-difluorobutoxy, 3,3-difluorobutoxy, 4,4-difluorobutoxy, 4,4,4-trifluorobutoxy or nonafluorobutoxy.
- Fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkoxy is additionally, for example, 5-fluoropentoxy, undecafluoropentoxy, 6-fluorohexoxy or tridecafluorohexoxy.
- C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy-C 1 -C 4 -alkyl refers to a straight-chain or branched alkyl group having 1 to 4 carbon atoms, as defined above, where one hydrogen atom is replaced by a C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy group, as defined above.
- C 1 -C 6 -alkoxy-C 1 -C 4 -alkyl refers to a straight-chain or branched alkyl group having 1 to 4 carbon atoms, as defined above, where one hydrogen atom is replaced by a C 1 -C 6 -alkoxy group, as defined above.
- Examples are methoxymethyl, ethoxymethyl, propoxymethyl, isopropoxymethyl, n-butoxymethyl, sec-butoxymethyl, isobutoxymethyl, tert-butoxymethyl, 1-methoxyethyl, 1-ethoxyethyl, 1-propoxyethyl, 1-isopropoxyethyl, 1-n-butoxyethyl, 1-sec-butoxyethyl, 1-isobutoxyethyl, 1-tert-butoxyethyl, 2-methoxyethyl, 2-ethoxyethyl, 2-propoxyethyl, 2-isopropoxyethyl, 2-n-butoxyethyl, 2-sec-butoxyethyl, 2-isobutoxyethyl, 2-tert-butoxyethyl, 1-methoxypropyl, 1-ethoxypropyl, 1-propoxypropyl, 1-isopropoxypropyl, 1-n-butoxypropyl, 1-sec-butoxypropyl,
- C 1 -C 2 -alkoxy-methyl refers to methyl where one hydrogen atom is replaced by a C 1 -C 2 -alkoxy group, as defined above. Examples are methoxymethyl and ethoxymethyl.
- C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy-methyl refers to methyl where one hydrogen atom is replaced by a C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy group, as defined above. Examples are methoxymethyl, ethoxymethyl, propoxymethyl, isopropoxymethyl, n-butoxymethyl, sec-butoxymethyl, isobutoxymethyl and tert-butoxymethyl.
- fluorinated C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy-C 1 -C 4 -alkyl refers to a straight-chain or branched alkyl group having 1 to 4 carbon atoms, as defined above, where one hydrogen atom is replaced by a C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy group, as defined above, and wherein at least one, e.g. 1, 2, 3, 4 or all of the remaining hydrogen atoms (either in the alkoxy moiety or in the alkyl moiety or in both) are replaced by fluorine atoms.
- fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkoxy-C 1 -C 4 -alkyl refers to a straight-chain or branched alkyl group having 1 to 4 carbon atoms, as defined above, where one hydrogen atom is replaced by a C 1 -C 6 -alkoxy group, as defined above, and wherein at least one, e.g. 1, 2, 3, 4 or all of the remaining hydrogen atoms (either in the alkoxy moiety or in the alkyl moiety or in both) are replaced by fluorine atoms.
- Examples are difluoromethoxymethyl (CHF 2 OCH 2 ), trifluoromethoxymethyl (CF 3 OCH 2 ), 1-difluoromethoxyethyl (CHF 2 OCH(CH 3 )), 1-trifluoromethoxyethyl (CF 3 OCH(CH 3 )), 2-difluoromethoxyethyl (CHF 2 OCH 2 CH 2 ), 2-trifluoromethoxyethyl (CF 3 OCH 2 CH 2 ), methoxy-difluoromethyl (CH 3 OCF 2 ), 2-methoxy-1,1-difluoroethyl (CH 3 OCH 2 CF 2 ), 2-methoxy-2,2-difluoroethyl (CH 3 OCF 2 CH 2 ), and the like.
- hydroxy-C 1 -C 4 -alkyl refers to a straight-chain or branched alkyl group having 1 to 4 carbon atoms, as defined above, where one hydrogen atom is replaced by a hydroxyl group.
- hydroxy-C 1 -C 6 -alkyl refers to a straight-chain or branched alkyl group having 1 to 6 carbon atoms, as defined above, where one hydrogen atom is replaced by a hydroxyl group.
- hydroxy-C 1 -C 4 -alkyl examples include hydroxymethyl, 1-hydroxyethyl, 2-hydroxyethyl, 1-hydroxypropyl, 2-hydroxypropyl, 3-hydroxypropyl, 1-hydroxyprop-2-yl, 2-hydroxyprop-2-yl, 1-hydroxybutyl, 2-hydroxybutyl, 3-hydroxybutyl, 4-hydroxybutyl, 1-hydroxybut-2-yl, 2-hydroxybut-2-yl, 3-hydroxybut-2-yl, 4-hydroxybut-2-yl, hydroxy-tert-butyl and the like.
- hydroxy-C 1 -C 6 -alkyl examples are, apart those mentioned for hydroxy-C 1 -C 4 -alkyl, 1-hydroxypentyl, 2-hydroxypentyl, 3-hydroxypentyl, 4-hydroxypentyl, 5-hydroxypentyl, 1-hydroxyhexyl, 2-hydroxyhexyl, 3-hydroxyhexyl, 4-hydroxyhexyl, 5-hydroxyhexyl, 6-hydroxyhexyl and the like.
- hydroxy-C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy refers to a C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy group, as defined above, where one hydrogen atom is replaced by a hydroxyl group.
- hydroxy-C 1 -C 6 -alkoxy refers to a C 1 -C 6 -alkoxy group, as defined above, where one hydrogen atom is replaced by a hydroxyl group.
- hydroxy-C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy examples include hydroxymethoxy, 1-hydroxyethoxy, 2-hydroxyethoxy, 1-hydroxypropoxy, 2-hydroxypropoxy, 3-hydroxypropoxy, 1-hydroxy-2-propoxy, 2-hydroxy-2-propoxy, 1-hydroxybutoxy, 2-hydroxybutoxy, 3-hydroxybutoxy, 4-hydroxybutoxy, 1-hydroxy-2-butoxy, 2-hydroxy-2-butoxy, 3-hydroxy-2-butoxy, 4-hydroxy-2-butoxy, hydroxy-tert-butoxy and the like.
- hydroxy-C 1 -C 6 -alkoxy examples include, apart those mentioned for hydroxy-C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy, 1-hydroxypentoxy, 2-hydroxypentoxy, 3-hydroxypentoxy, 4-hydroxypentoxy, 5-hydroxypentoxy, 1-hydroxyhexoxy, 2-hydroxyhexoxy, 3-hydroxyhexoxy, 4-hydroxyhexoxy, 5-hydroxyhexoxy, 6-hydroxyhexoxy and the like.
- C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy-C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy refers to a C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy group, as defined above, where one hydrogen atom is replaced by a C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy group, as defined above.
- C 1 -C 6 -alkoxy-C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy refers to a C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy group, as defined above, where one hydrogen atom is replaced by a C 1 -C 6 -alkoxy group, as defined above.
- Examples are methoxymethoxy, ethoxymethoxy, propoxymethoxy, isopropoxymethoxy, butoxymethoxy, sec-butoxymethoxy, isobutoxymethoxy, tert-butoxymethoxy, 1-methoxyethoxy, 1-ethoxyethoxy, 1-propoxyethoxy, 1-isopropoxyethoxy, 1-butoxyethoxy, 1-sec-butoxyethoxy, 1-isobutoxyethoxy, 1-tert-butoxyethoxy, 2-methoxyethoxy, 2-ethoxyethoxy, 2-propoxyethoxy, 2-isopropoxyethoxy, 2-butoxyethoxy, 2-sec-butoxyethoxy, 2-isobutoxyethoxy, 2-tert-butoxyethoxy, 1-methoxypropoxy, 1-ethoxypropoxy, 1-propoxypropoxy, 1-isopropoxypropoxy, 1-butoxypropoxy, 1-sec-butoxypropoxy, 1-isobutoxypropoxy, 1-tert-butoxyprop
- C 1 -C 2 -alkylthio is a C 1 -C 2 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfur atom.
- C 1 -C 3 -alkylthio refers to a C 1 -C 3 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfur atom.
- C 1 -C 4 -alkylthio is a C 1 -C 4 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfur atom.
- C 1 -C 6 -alkylthio refers to a C 1 -C 6 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfur atom.
- C 1 -C 10 -alkylthio refers to a C 1 -C 10 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfur atom.
- C 1 -C 2 -Alkylthio is methylthio or ethylthio.
- C 1 -C 3 -Alkylthio is additionally, for example, n-propylthio or 1-methylethylthio (isopropylthio).
- C 1 -C 4 -Alkylthio is additionally, for example, butylthio, 1-methylpropylthio (sec-butylthio), 2-methylpropylthio (isobutylthio) or 1,1-dimethylethylthio (tert-butylthio).
- C 1 -C 6 -Alkylthio is additionally, for example, pentylthio, 1-methylbutylthio, 2-methylbutylthio, 3-methylbutylthio, 1,1-dimethylpropylthio, 1,2-dimethylpropylthio, 2,2-dimethylpropylthio, 1-ethylpropylthio, hexylthio, 1-methylpentylthio, 2-methylpentylthio, 3-methylpentylthio, 4-methylpentylthio, 1,1-dimethylbutylthio, 1,2-dimethylbutylthio, 1,3-dimethylbutylthio, 2,2-dimethylbutylthio, 2,3-dimethylbutylthio, 3,3-dimethylbutylthio, 1-ethylbutylthio, 2-ethylbutylthio, 1,1,2-trimethylpropylthio, 1,2,2-trimethylpropylthio,
- fluorinated C 1 -C 2 -alkylthio refers to a fluorinated C 1 -C 2 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfur atom.
- fluorinated C 1 -C 3 -alkylthio refers to a fluorinated C 1 -C 3 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfur atom.
- fluorinated C 1 -C 4 -alkylthio refers to a fluorinated C 1 -C 4 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfur atom.
- fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkylthio refers to a fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfur atom.
- Fluorinated C 1 -C 2 -alkylthio refers to, for example, SCH 2 F, SCHF 2 , SCF 3 , 2-fluoroethylthio, 2,2-difluoroethylthio, 2,2,2-trifluoroethylthio, or SC 2 F 5 .
- Fluorinated C 1 -C 3 -alkylthio may additionally, for example, include 2-fluoropropylthio, 3-fluoropropylthio, 2,2-difluoropropylthio, 2,3-difluoropropylthio, 3,3,3-trifluoropropylthio, SCH 2 —C 2 F 5 , SCF 2 —C 2 F 5 or 1-(CH 2 F)-2-fluoroethylthio.
- Fluorinated C 1 -C 4 -alkylthio may additionally, for example, include 4-fluorobutylthio or nonafluorobutylthio.
- Fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkylthio is additionally, for example, 5-fluoropentylthio, undecafluoropentylthio, 6-fluorohexylthio or dodecafluorohexylthio.
- C 1 -C 2 -alkylsulfinyl refers to a C 1 -C 2 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfinyl [S(O)] group.
- C 1 -C 4 -alkylsulfinyl is a C 1 -C 4 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfinyl [S(O)] group.
- C 1 -C 6 -alkylsulfinyl is a C 1 -C 6 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfinyl [S(O)] group.
- C 1 -C 2 -Alkylsulfinyl is methylsulfinyl or ethylsulfinyl.
- C 1 -C 4 -Alkylsulfinyl is additionally, for example, n-propylsulfinyl, 1-methylethylsulfinyl (isopropylsulfinyl), butylsulfinyl, 1-methylpropylsulfinyl (sec-butylsulfinyl), 2-methylpropylsulfinyl (isobutylsulfinyl) or 1,1-dimethylethylsulfinyl (tert-butylsulfinyl).
- C 1 -C 6 -Alkylsulfinyl is additionally, for example, pentylsulfinyl, 1-methylbutylsulfinyl, 2-methylbutylsulfinyl, 3-methylbutylsulfinyl, 1,1-dimethylpropylsulfinyl, 1,2-dimethylpropylsulfinyl, 2,2-dimethylpropylsulfinyl, 1-ethylpropylsulfinyl, hexylsulfinyl, 1-methylpentylsulfinyl, 2-methylpentylsulfinyl, 3-methylpentylsulfinyl, 4-methylpentylsulfinyl, 1,1-dimethylbutylsulfinyl, 1,2-dimethylbutylsulfinyl, 1,3-dimethylbutylsulfinyl, 2,2-dimethylbutylsulf
- fluorinated C 1 -C 2 -alkylsulfinyl refers to a fluorinated C 1 -C 2 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfinyl [S(O)] group.
- fluorinated C 1 -C 3 -alkylsulfinyl refers to a fluorinated C 1 -C 3 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfinyl [S(O)] group.
- fluorinated C 1 -C 4 -alkylsulfinyl refers to a fluorinated C 1 -C 4 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfinyl [S(O)] group.
- fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkylsulfinyl refers to a fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfinyl [S(O)] group.
- Fluorinated C 1 -C 2 -alkylsulfinyl is, for example, S(O)CH 2 F, S(O)CHF 2 , S(O)CF 3 , 2-fluoroethylsulfinyl, 2,2-difluoroethylsulfinyl, 2,2,2-trifluoroethylsulfinyl, or S(O)C 2 F 5 .
- Fluorinated C 1 -C 3 -alkylsulfinyl may additionally, for example, include 2-fluoropropylsulfinyl, 3-fluoropropylsulfinyl, 2,2-difluoropropylsulfinyl, 2,3-difluoropropylsulfinyl, 3,3,3-trifluoropropylsulfinyl, S(O)CH 2 —C 2 F 5 , S(O)CF 2 —C 2 F 5 or 1-(CH 2 F)-2-fluoroethylsulfinyl.
- Fluorinated C 1 -C 4 -alkylsulfinyl may additionally, for example, include 4-fluorobutylsulfinyl or nonafluorobutylsulfinyl.
- Fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkylsulfinyl may additionally, for example, include 5-fluoropentylsulfinyl, undecafluoropentylsulfinyl, 6-fluorohexylsulfinyl or dodecafluorohexylsulfinyl.
- C 1 -C 2 -alkylsulfonyl refers to a C 1 -C 2 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfonyl [S(O) 2 ] group.
- C 1 -C 4 -alkylsulfonyl refers to a C 1 -C 4 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfonyl [S(O) 2 ] group.
- C 1 -C 6 -alkylsulfonyl is a C 1 -C 6 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfonyl [S(O) 2 ] group.
- C 1 -C 2 -Alkylsulfonyl refers to a methylsulfonyl or ethylsulfonyl.
- C 1 -C 4 -Alkylsulfonyl is additionally, for example, n-propylsulfonyl, 1-methylethylsulfonyl (isopropylsulfonyl), butylsulfonyl, 1-methylpropylsulfonyl (sec-butylsulfonyl), 2-methylpropylsulfonyl (isobutylsulfonyl) or 1,1-dimethylethylsulfonyl (tert-butylsulfonyl).
- C 1 -C 6 -Alkylsulfonyl is additionally, for example, pentylsulfonyl, 1-methylbutylsulfonyl, 2-methylbutylsulfonyl, 3-methylbutylsulfonyl, 1,1-dimethylpropylsulfonyl, 1,2-dimethylpropylsulfonyl, 2,2-dimethylpropylsulfonyl, 1-ethylpropylsulfonyl, hexylsulfonyl, 1-methylpentylsulfonyl, 2-methylpentylsulfonyl, 3-methylpentylsulfonyl, 4-methylpentylsulfonyl, 1,1-dimethylbutylsulfonyl, 1,2-dimethylbutylsulfonyl, 1,3-dimethylbutylsulfonyl, 2,2-dimethylbutylsulf
- fluorinated C 1 -C 2 -alkylsulfonyl refers to a fluorinated C 1 -C 2 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfonyl [S(O) 2 ] group.
- fluorinated C 1 -C 3 -alkylsulfonyl refers to a fluorinated C 1 -C 3 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfonyl [S(O) 2 ] group.
- fluorinated C 1 -C 4 -alkylsulfonyl refers to a fluorinated C 1 -C 4 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfonyl [S(O) 2 ] group.
- fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkylsulfonyl refers to a fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfonyl [S(O) 2 ] group.
- Fluorinated C 1 -C 2 -alkylsulfonyl is, for example, S(O) 2 CH 2 F, S(O) 2 CHF 2 , S(O) 2 CF 3 , 2-fluoroethylsulfonyl, 2,2-difluoroethylsulfonyl, 2,2,2-trifluoroethylsulfonyl, S(O) 2 C 2 F 5 .
- Fluorinated C 1 -C 3 -alkylsulfonyl is additionally, for example, 2-fluoropropylsulfonyl, 3-fluoropropylsulfonyl, 2,2-difluoropropylsulfonyl, 2,3-difluoropropylsulfonyl, 3,3,3-trifluoropropylsulfonyl, S(O) 2 CH 2 —C 2 F 5 , S(O) 2 CF 2 —C 2 F 5 or 1-(CH 2 F)-2-fluoroethylsulfonyl.
- Fluorinated C 1 -C 4 -alkylsulfonyl is additionally, for example, 4-fluorobutylsulfonyl or nonafluorobutylsulfonyl.
- Fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkylsulfonyl is additionally, for example, 5-fluoropentylsulfonyl, undecafluoropentylsulfonyl, 6-fluorohexylsulfonyl or dodecafluorohexylsulfonyl.
- C 1 -C 4 -Alkylcarbonyl refers to a straight-chain or branched alkyl group having from 1 to 4 carbon atoms), which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a carbonyl group (CO), such as in acetyl, propionyl, isopropylcarbonyl, butylcarbonyl, sec-butylcarbonyl, isobutylcarbonyl, and tert-butylcarbonyl.
- C 1 -C 6 -Alkylcarbonyl is a straight-chain or branched alkyl group having from 1 to 6 carbon atoms, which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a carbonyl group (CO). Examples include, apart those listed above for C 1 -C 4 -alkylcarbonylpentylcarbonyl, hexylcarbonyl and the constitutional isomers thereof.
- Fluorinated C 1 -C 4 -alkylcarbonyl refers to a straight-chain or branched fluorinated alkyl group having from 1 to 4 carbon atoms as defined above, which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a carbonyl group (CO).
- Fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkylcarbonyl is a straight-chain or branched fluorinated alkyl group having from 1 to 6 carbon atoms as defined above, which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a carbonyl group (CO). Examples include trifluoromethylcarbonyl, 2,2,2-trifluoroethylcarbonyl and the like.
- C 3 -C 6 -cycloalkylcarbonyl relates to a C 3 -C 6 -cycloalkyl group as defined above which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a carbonyl group (CO), such as in cyclopropylcarbonyl, cyclobutylcarbonyl, cyclopentylcarbonyl and cyclohexylcarbonyl.
- CO carbonyl group
- C 1 -C 6 -Alkoxycarbonyl refers to a straight-chain or branched alkoxy group having from 1 to 6, especially 1 to 4 carbon atoms ( ⁇ C 1 -C 4 -alkoxycarbonyl), in particular 1 to 3 carbon atoms ( ⁇ C 1 -C 3 -alkoxycarbonyl), which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a carbonyl group (CO), such as in methoxycarbonyl, ethoxycarbonyl, propyloxycarbonyl, and isopropyloxycarbonyl.
- CO carbonyl group
- Examples include trifluoromethoxycarbonyl, 2,2,2-trifluoroethoxycarbonyl and the like.
- C 1 -C 4 -Alkylcarbonyloxy refers to a straight-chain or branched alkyl group having from 1 to 4 carbon atoms, which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a carbonyloxy group [C(O)—O—], such as in acet(yl)oxy, propionyloxy, isopropylcarbonyloxy, butylcarbonyloxy, sec-butylcarbonyloxy, isobutylcarbonyloxy, and tert-butylcarbonyloxy.
- C 1 -C 6 -Alkylcarbonyloxy is a straight-chain or branched alkyl group having from 1 to 6 carbon atoms, which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a carbonyloxy group [C(O—O—]. Examples include, apart those listed above for C 1 -C 4 -alkylcarbonyloxy, pentylcarbonyloxy, hexylcarbonyloxy and the constitutional isomers thereof.
- Fluorinated C 1 -C 4 -alkylcarbonyloxy refers to a straight-chain or branched fluorinated alkyl group having from 1 to 4 carbon atoms as defined above, which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a carbonyloxy group [C(O)—O—].
- Fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkylcarbonyloxy is a straight-chain or branched fluorinated alkyl group having from 1 to 6 carbon atoms as defined above, which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a carbonyloxy group [C(O)—O—]. Examples include trifluoromethylcarbonyloxy, 2,2,2-trifluoroethylcarbonyloxy and the like.
- Phenyl-C 1 -C 2 -alkyl is a phenyl group bound to the remainder of the molecule via a C 1 -C 2 -alkyl group. Examples are benzyl, 1-phenylethyl and 2-phenylethyl (phenethyl).
- the term “3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated heterocyclic ring containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom groups independently selected from N, O, S, NO, SO and SO 2 and optionally also 1 or 2 C ⁇ O and/or C ⁇ S groups as ring members” denotes a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered, preferably a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6- or 7-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximum unsaturated heteromonocyclic ring containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 (preferably 1, 2 or 3) heteroatoms or heteroatom groups selected from N, O, S, SO and SO 2 and optionally also 1 or 2 C ⁇ O and/or C ⁇ S groups as ring members.
- Unsaturated rings contain at least one C—C and/or C—N and/or N—N double bond(s). Maximally unsaturated rings contain as many conjugated C—C and/or C—N and/or N—N double bonds as allowed by the ring size. Maximally unsaturated 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic rings are aromatic. 7- and 8-membered rings cannot be aromatic. They are homoaromatic (7-membered ring, 3 double bonds) or have 4 double bonds (8-membered ring). Partially unsaturated rings contain less than the maximum number of C—C and/or C—N and/or N—N double bond(s) allowed by the ring size.
- the heterocyclic ring may be attached to the remainder of the molecule via a carbon ring member or via a nitrogen ring member.
- the heterocyclic ring contains at least one carbon ring atom. If the ring contains more than one O ring atom, these are not adjacent.
- this nitrogen atom may either be present as tertiary N formally bound by a double and a single bond (like in pyridyl) or may be present as secondary NH (if N is not part of a ring double bond).
- the substituent may either be bound to a carbon ring atom or to such a secondary nitrogen ring atom.
- the ring may either be bound to the remainder of the molecule via a carbon ring atom or such a secondary nitrogen ring atom.
- Examples of a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6- or 7-membered saturated heterocyclic ring include: Oxiranyl, thiiranyl, aziridinyl, oxetanyl, thietanyl, azetidinyl, tetrahydrofuran-2-yl, tetrahydrofuran-3-yl, tetrahydrofuran-2-on-3-yl, tetrahydrofuran-2-on-4-yl, tetrahydrofuran-2-on-5-yl, tetrahydrofuran-2-thion-3-yl, tetrahydrofuran-2-thion-4-yl, tetrahydrofuran-2-thion-5-yl, tetrahydrothien-2-yl, tetrahydrothien-3-yl, tetrahydrothien-2-on-3-yl, tetrahydrothien-2-on-4-yl, te
- Examples of a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated heterocyclic ring further include oxocane, thiocane, azocane, [1,3]diazocane, [1,4]diazocane, [1,5]diazocane, [1,5]oxazocane and the like.
- Examples of a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6- or 7-membered partially unsaturated heterocyclic ring include: 2,3-dihydrofur-2-yl, 2,3-dihydrofur-3-yl, 2,4-dihydrofur-2-yl, 2,4-dihydrofur-3-yl, 2,3-dihydrothien-2-yl, 2,3-dihydrothien-3-yl, 2,4-dihydrothien-2-yl, 2,4-dihydrothien-3-yl, 2-pyrrolin-2-yl, 2-pyrrolin-3-yl, 3-pyrrolin-2-yl, 3-pyrrolin-3-yl, 2-isoxazolin-3-yl, 3-isoxazolin-3-yl, 4-isoxazolin-3-yl, 2-isoxazolin-4-yl, 3-isoxazolin-4-yl, 4-isoxazolin-4-yl, 2-isoxazolin-5-y
- Examples of a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered partially unsaturated heterocyclic ring further include 1,2,3,4,5,6-hexahydroazocine, 2,3,4,5,6,7-hexahydroazocine, 1,2,3,4,5,8-hexahydroazocine, 1,2,3,4,7,8-hexahydroazocine, 1,2,3,4,5,6-hexahydro-[1,5]diazocine,1,2,3,4,7,8-hexahydro-[1,5]diazocine and the like.
- Examples of a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6- or 7-membered maximally unsaturated (including aromatic) heterocyclic ring include 5- or 6-membered heteroaromatic rings, such as 2-furyl, 3-furyl, 2-thienyl, 3-thienyl, 1-pyrrolyl, 2-pyrrolyl, 3-pyrrolyl, 1-pyrazolyl, 3-pyrazolyl, 4-pyrazolyl, 5-pyrazolyl, 2-oxazolyl, 4-oxazolyl, 5-oxazolyl, 2-thiazolyl, 4-thiazolyl, 5-thiazolyl, 1-imidazolyl, 2-imidazolyl, 4-imidazolyl, 1,3,4-triazol-1-yl, 1,3,4-triazol-2-yl, 2-pyridinyl, 3-pyridinyl, 4-pyridinyl, 1-oxopyridin-2-yl, 1-oxopyridin-3-yl, 1-oxopyridin-4-yl, 3-pyri
- Examples of a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered maximally unsaturated heterocyclic ring further include [1,3]diazocine, [1,5]diazocine and [1,5]diazocine.
- a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated ring containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom groups independently selected from N, O, S, NO, SO, SO 2 , C ⁇ O and C ⁇ S as ring members is either saturated, partially unsaturated and carbocyclic (if it contains only C ⁇ O and/or C ⁇ S as heteroatom group and no further heteroatoms or heteroatom groups) or saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated heterocyclic.
- Examples are, in addition to the heterocyclic rings mentioned above, carbocyclic rings, such as cyclopropanonyl, cyclobutanonyl, cyclopentanonyl, cyclohexanonyl, cyclohexandionyl, cycloheptanonyl, cyclooctanonyl, cyclopropanthionyl, cyclobutanthionyl, cyclopentanthionyl, cyclohexanthionyl, cyclohexandithionyl, cycloheptanthionyl, cyclooctanthionyl, cyclopropenonyl, cyclopentenonyl, cyclohexenonyl and the like.
- carbocyclic rings such as cyclopropanonyl, cyclobutanonyl, cyclopentanonyl, cyclohexanonyl, cyclohexandionyl,
- R 1 is selected from hydrogen and C 1 -C 6 -alkyl, in particular from hydrogen and methyl, and is specifically hydrogen.
- R 2 is selected from cyano, nitro, C 1 -C 6 -alkyl, fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkyl, C 1 -C 6 -alkoxy-C 1 -C 4 -alkyl and fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkoxy-C 1 -C 4 -alkyl, more preferably from C 1 -C 6 -alkyl, fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkyl, C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy-C 1 -C 4 -alkyl and fluorinated C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy-C 1 -C 4 -alkyl, even more preferably from C 1 -C 6 -alkyl and fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkyl, in particular from methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl and CF 3 , more particularly from methyl, ethyl and
- R 3a and R 3b independently of each other, are selected from hydrogen, cyano, nitro, C 1 -C 6 -alkyl and fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkyl. More preferably, R 3a is selected from hydrogen, cyano, nitro, C 1 -C 6 -alkyl and fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkyl, and R 3b is hydrogen. Even more preferably, R 3a is selected from hydrogen and methyl and R 3b is hydrogen. In particular, both R 3a and R 3b are hydrogen.
- R 4a and R 4b independently of each other, are selected from hydrogen, C 1 -C 6 -alkyl, fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkyl, C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy-C 1 -C 4 -alkyl and fluorinated C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy-C 1 -C 4 -alkyl, or form together a group ⁇ O, or form together a group —(CH 2 ) m —, where m is 2, 3 or 4, in particular 2 or 3, especially 2, thus forming together a spiro-bound ring.
- R 4a is selected from hydrogen, C 1 -C 6 -alkyl, fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkyl, C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy-C 1 -C 4 -alkyl and fluorinated C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy-C 1 -C4-alkyl and R 4b is hydrogen, or R 4a and R 4b are methyl, or R 4a and R 4b form together a group —(CH 2 ) m —, where m is 2, 3 or 4, in particular 2 or 3, especially 2, thus forming together a spiro-bound ring. In a particular embodiment, they are hydrogen.
- R 5a is selected from hydrogen, halogen, C 1 -C 6 -alkyl, fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkyl and C 1 -C 6 -alkoxy-C 1 -C 4 -alkyl and R 5b is hydrogen.
- R 5a is hydrogen or methyl, specifically hydrogen, and R 5b is hydrogen.
- each R 8 as a substituent on R 6 is independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, C 1 -C 6 -alkoxy and fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkoxy.
- R 8 is halogen, especially fluorine.
- R 6 is thus preferably C 1 -C 4 -haloalkyl, more preferably fluorinated C 1 -C 4 -alkyl, in particular fluorinated C 1 -C 2 -alkyl, such as CH 2 F, CHF 2 , CF 3 and CH 2 CF 3 , and specifically fluorinated methyl; very specifically CHF 2 or CF 3 .
- R 6 is preferably selected from C 1 -C 6 -alkoxy-C 1 -C 4 -alkyl and fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkoxy-C 1 -C 4 -alkyl, and is in particular fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkoxy-C 1 -C 4 -alkyl.
- R 6 is C 1 -C 6 -alkoxy-C 1 -C 4 -alkyl, specifically C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy-methyl and very specifically C 1 -C 2 -alkoxy-methyl.
- R 6 is C 1 -C 4 -alkyl which carries a hydroxyl substituent.
- each R 7 is independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, cyano, nitro, hydroxyl, C 1 -C 6 -alkyl, fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkyl, C 2 -C 6 -alkenyl, fluorinated C 2 -C 6 -alkenyl, C 2 -C 6 -alkynyl, fluorinated C 2 -C 6 -alkynyl, C 3 -C 8 -cycloalkyl, fluorinated C 3 -C 8 -cycloalkyl, C 1 -C 6 -alkoxy and fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkoxy.
- each R 7 is independently selected from halogen, C 1 -C 4 -alkyl, fluorinated C 1 -C 4 -alkyl, C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy and fluorinated C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy, and is in particular fluorine.
- a is 0 or 1. If a is 1, R 2 is preferably bound in ⁇ -position to the nitrogen ring atom carrying R 1 .
- b is 0 or 1 and specifically 0.
- R 9 , R 10 , R 11a and R 11b have following preferred meanings:
- each R 9 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, hydroxyl, C 1 -C 6 -alkyl, fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkyl, C 1 -C 6 -hydroxyalkyl, C 3 -C 6 -cycloalkyl, fluorinated C 3 -C 6 -cycloalkyl, C 1 -C 6 -alkoxy, fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkoxy, and —NR 11a R 11b , where R 11a and R 11b have one of the above general or, in particular, one of the below preferred meanings.
- each R 9 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C 1 -C 4 -alkyl, fluorinated C 1 -C 2 -alkyl, C 1 -C 4 -hydroxyalkyl, C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy, fluorinated C 1 -C 2 -alkoxy, and —NR 11a R 11b , where R 11a and R 11b have one of the above general or, in particular, one of the below preferred meanings.
- each R 10 is independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, cyano, C 1 -C 4 -alkyl, fluorinated C 1 -C 4 -alkyl, C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy and fluorinated C 1 -C 4 -alkoxy, more preferably from F, Cl, cyano, CH 3 , CF 3 , OCH 3 and OCF 3 , and in particular from F, CH 3 , CF 3 , OCH 3 and OCF 3 .
- R 11a and R 11b are selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C 1 -C 6 -alkyl, fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkyl, C 1 -C 6 -alkylcarbonyl and fluorinated C 1 -C 6 -alkylcarbonyl.
- the compounds of the invention are compounds of formula I.1
- R 2 , R 6 , R 7 and b have one of the above general or, in particular, one of the above preferred meanings, and a is 0 or 1.
- the compounds of the invention are compounds of formula I.1.1
- R 2 is specifically methyl
- Examples of preferred compounds are compounds of the following formulae Ia.1 to Ia.36, where the variables have one of the general or preferred meanings given above.
- Examples of preferred compounds are the individual compounds compiled in the tables 1 to 9360 below. Moreover, the meanings mentioned below for the individual variables in the tables are per se, independently of the combination in which they are mentioned, a particularly preferred embodiment of the substituents in question.
- the invention relates to compounds I selected from the compounds of the examples, either in form of free bases or of any pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof or a stereoisomer, the racemate or any mixture of stereoisomers thereof.
- the compounds of the present invention can be prepared by using routine techniques familiar to a skilled person.
- the compounds of the formula I can be prepared according to the following schemes, wherein the variables, if not stated otherwise, are as defined above.
- Quinoline 2 is then N-alkylated with a suitable protective group, such as benzyl, e.g. by reaction with benzyl bromide, to 3. Reduction of the quinolinium compound 3 with a suitable reduction agent, such as sodium borohydride and H 2 /Raney nickel, yields the 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinoline 4, which is then deprotected to 5.
- a suitable protective group such as benzyl
- benzyl bromide to 3.
- lactam 13 is then reduced with common reduction agents, like borane, borane-tetrahydrofurane-complex, borane-dimethylsulfide-complex or borohydrides such as sodium borohydride, to the tetrahydroquinoline 14.
- common reduction agents like borane, borane-tetrahydrofurane-complex, borane-dimethylsulfide-complex or borohydrides such as sodium borohydride
- reaction with the 2-halogenoacetamide 6, wherein Y is Cl, Br or I affords the acetamide 15, the keto group of which is reduced with common reduction agents, like borane, borane-tetrahydrofurane-complex, borane-dimethylsulfide-complex or borohydrides such as sodium borohydride or LAH (lithium aluminium hydride) or DIBAL-H (diisobutyl aluminium hydride), to 16.
- common reduction agents like borane, borane-tetrahydrofurane-complex, borane-dimethylsulfide-complex or borohydrides such as sodium borohydride or LAH (lithium aluminium hydride) or DIBAL-H (diisobutyl aluminium hydride), to 16.
- Cyclization with formaldehyde/aldehyde/ketone 9 generally in the presence of a strong acid, such as trifluoroacetic acid, yields I′′
- Reaction of 21 with a Lewis acid or a Brönstedt acid HA or irradiation with a suitable wavelength commonly derived from a mercury lamp in an adequate solvent, such as acetone or toluene, in a common photoreactor yields cyclization to 22.
- Reduction of the carbonyl group with common reduction agents like borohydrides such as sodium borohydride or borane-tetrahydrofurane-complex yields 23, which is deprotected using suitable reagents such as strong bases or acids to I′′, wherein R 4a and R 4b and R 5b are H.
- Compounds I′′′′ wherein R 4a and R 4b form together ⁇ O can be obtained by skipping the reduction step to 23 and deprotecting 22.
- compound 22 can be directly synthesized by reacting the tetrahydrobenzodiazepine 19, wherein Z is —B(OH) 2 with the acrylic acid derivative 20 in a 1,4-addition in the presence of a Rhodium catalyst, e.g. [RhOH(COD)] 2 or Rh(acac)(CO) 2 , if desired in the presence of a phosphine ligand, such as 1,4-bis(diphenylphosphino)butane (dppb), followed by lactam formation to 22. This is then further reacted as described above.
- a Rhodium catalyst e.g. [RhOH(COD)] 2 or Rh(acac)(CO) 2
- a phosphine ligand such as 1,4-bis(diphenylphosphino)butane (dppb)
- substituents R 1 different from hydrogen can be introduced for example via alkylation under typical conditions such as stirring in an appropriate solvent in the presence of an alkylhalide and a base or via other common substitution reactions, or via reductive amination using a suitable aldehyde or ketone in the presence of reduction agent, such as borohydrides, e.g. triacetoxyborohydride, sodium cyanoborohydride or sodium borohydride.
- borohydrides e.g. triacetoxyborohydride, sodium cyanoborohydride or sodium borohydride.
- —C( ⁇ O)R 9 as radical R 1 can be introduced via amidation under typical amidation conditions, e.g.
- a coupling reagent such as DCC (dicyclohexylcarbodiimide), DIC (diisopropylcarbodiimide), HATU (O-(7-azabenzotriazol-1-yl)-N,N,N′,N′-tetramethyluronium hexafluorophosphate), HBTU ((O-benzotriazol-1-yl)-N,N,N′,N′-tetramethyluronium hexafluorophosphate), HCTU (1H-benzotriazolium-1-[bis(dimethylamino)methylene]-5-chloro tetrafluoroborate), BOP ((benzotriazol-1-yloxy)-tris(dimethylamino)phosphonium hexafluorophosphat
- Compounds I wherein R 5b is different from H can be prepared, for example, by reacting compound 22 with a compound LG-R 5b in the presence of a base, wherein LG is an appropriate leaving group, such as Cl or Br.
- R 4a and R 4b are not H or do not form together a group ⁇ O
- compounds wherein R 4a and R 4b form together a group ⁇ S may be prepared by reaction with a sulfurization agent, such as Lawesson's reagent or P 2 S 5 .
- Alkyl and related groups as radicals R 4a and R 4b may be introduced via Grignard reduction.
- Amino and related groups may be introduced via reductive amination.
- Hydroxyl group R 4a or R 4b may be introduced by reducing the carbonyl group. This may be alkylated to yield alkoxy and related groups R 4a and R 4b or substituted by diverse groups.
- the above-described reactions are generally carried out in a solvent at temperatures between room temperature and the boiling temperature of the solvent employed.
- the activation energy which is required for the reaction can be introduced into the reaction mixture using microwaves, something which has proved to be of value, in particular, in the case of the reactions catalyzed by transition metals (with regard to reactions using microwaves, see Tetrahedron 2001, 57, p. 9199 ff. p. 9225 ff. and also, in a general manner, “Microwaves in Organic Synthesis”, André Loupy (Ed.), Wiley-VCH 2002.
- the acid addition salts of compounds I are prepared in a customary manner by mixing the free base with a corresponding acid, where appropriate in solution in an organic solvent, for example a lower alcohol, such as methanol, ethanol or propanol, an ether, such as methyl tert-butyl ether or diisopropyl ether, a ketone, such as acetone or methyl ethyl ketone, or an ester, such as ethyl acetate.
- an organic solvent for example a lower alcohol, such as methanol, ethanol or propanol, an ether, such as methyl tert-butyl ether or diisopropyl ether, a ketone, such as acetone or methyl ethyl ketone, or an ester, such as ethyl acetate.
- Routine experimentations including appropriate manipulation of the reaction conditions, reagents and sequence of the synthetic route, protection of any chemical functionality that may not be compatible with the reaction conditions, and deprotection at a suitable point in the reaction sequence of the preparation methods are within routine techniques.
- Suitable protecting groups and the methods for protecting and deprotecting different substituents using such suitable protecting groups are well known to those skilled in the art; examples of which may be found in T. Greene and P. Wuts, Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis (3 rd ed.), John Wiley & Sons, NY (1999), which is herein incorporated by reference in its entirety. Synthesis of the compounds of the invention may be accomplished by methods analogous to those described in the synthetic schemes described hereinabove and in specific examples.
- an optically active form of a compound of the invention when required, it may be obtained by carrying out one of the procedures described herein using an optically active starting material (prepared, for example, by asymmetric induction of a suitable reaction step), or by resolution of a mixture of the stereoisomers of the compound or intermediates using a standard procedure (such as chromatographic separation, recrystallization or enzymatic resolution).
- an optically active starting material prepared, for example, by asymmetric induction of a suitable reaction step
- resolution of a mixture of the stereoisomers of the compound or intermediates using a standard procedure (such as chromatographic separation, recrystallization or enzymatic resolution).
- a pure geometric isomer of a compound of the invention when required, it may be obtained by carrying out one of the above procedures using a pure geometric isomer as a starting material, or by resolution of a mixture of the geometric isomers of the compound or intermediates using a standard procedure such as chromatographic separation.
- the present invention further relates to a pharmaceutical composition
- a pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount of at least one compound as defined above or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, in combination with at least one pharmaceutically acceptable carrier and/or auxiliary substance.
- the present invention further relates to a compound I as defined above or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof for use as a medicament.
- the present invention also relates to a compound I as defined above or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof for the treatment of disorders which respond to the modulation of the 5-HT 2C receptor.
- the present invention also relates to the use of a compound I as defined above or of an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof for the manufacture of a medicament for the treatment of disorders which respond to the modulation of the 5-HT 2C receptor, and to a method for treating disorders which respond to the modulation of the 5-HT 2C receptor, which method comprises administering to a subject in need thereof at least one compound I as defined above or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
- the compounds of the present invention are modulators of the 5-HT 2C receptor.
- the compounds of formula I are agonists or partial agonists of the 5-HT 2C receptor.
- the invention relates to a compound I as defined above or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof for the treatment of disorders which respond to 5-HT 2C receptor agonists, further to the use of a compound I as defined above or of an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof for the manufacture of a medicament for the treatment of disorders which respond to 5-HT 2C receptor agonists, and to a method for treating disorders which respond to 5-HT 2C receptor agonists, which method comprises administering to a subject in need thereof at least one compound I as defined above or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
- disorder denotes disturbances and/or anomalies which are as a rule regarded as being pathological conditions or functions and which can manifest themselves in the form of particular signs, symptoms and/or malfunctions. While the treatment according to the invention can be directed toward individual disorders, i.e. anomalies or pathological conditions, it is also possible for several anomalies, which may be causatively linked to each other, to be combined into patterns, i.e. syndromes, which can be treated in accordance with the invention.
- the diseases to be treated are disorders are damage of the central nervous system, disorders of the central nervous system, eating disorders, ocular hypertension, cardiovascular disorders, gastrointestinal disorders and diabetes.
- disorders or diseases of the central nervous system are understood as meaning disorders which affect the spinal cord and, in particular, the brain. These are, for example, cognitive dysfunction, attention deficit disorder/hyperactivity syndrome and cognitive deficits related with schizophrenia, attention deficit/hyperactivity syndrome, personality disorders, affective disorders, motion or motor disorders, pain, migraine, sleep disorders (including disturbances of the Circadian rhythm), feeding disorders, diseases associated with neurodegeneration, addiction diseases, obesity or psoriasis.
- Examples of cognitive dysfunction are deficits in memory, cognition, and learning, Alzheimer's disease, age-related cognitive decline, and mild cognitive impairment, or any combinations thereof.
- Examples of personality disorders are schizophrenia and cognitive deficits related to schizophrenia.
- Examples of affective disorders are depression, anxiety, bipolar disorder and obsessive compulsive disorders, or any combination thereof.
- Examples of motion or motor disorders are Parkinson's disease and epilepsy.
- Examples of feeding disorders are obesity, bulimia, weight loss and anorexia, especially anorexia nervosa.
- Examples of diseases associated with neurodegeneration are stroke, spinal or head trauma, and head injuries, such as hydrocephalus.
- Pain condition includes nociceptive pain, neuropathic pain or a combination thereof.
- pain conditions or disorders can include, but are not limited to, post-operative pain, osteoarthritis pain, pain due to inflammation, rheumatoid arthritis pain, musculoskeletal pain, burn pain (including sunburn), ocular pain, the pain associated with dental conditions (such as dental caries and gingivitis), post-partum pain, bone fracture, herpes, HIV, traumatic nerve injury, stroke, post-ischemia, fibromyalgia, reflex sympathetic dystrophy, complex regional pain syndrome, spinal cord injury, sciatica, phantom limb pain, diabetic neuropathy, hyperalgesia and cancer.
- the disease condition is bladder dysfunction, including urinary incontinence.
- Diabetes includes diabetes insipidus, diabetes mellitus, type I diabetes, type II diabetes, type III diabetes, diabetes secondary to pancreatic diseases, diabetes related to steroid use, diabetes complications, hyperglycemia and insulin resistance.
- the addiction diseases include psychiatric disorders and behavioral disturbances which are caused by the abuse of psychotropic substances, such as pharmaceuticals or narcotics, and also other addiction diseases, such as addiction to gaming (impulse control disorders not elsewhere classified).
- addictive substances are: opioids (e.g. morphine, heroin and codeine), cocaine; nicotine; alcohol; substances which interact with the GABA chloride channel complex, sedatives, hypnotics and tranquilizers, for example benzodiazepines; LSD; cannabinoids; psychomotor stimulants, such as 3,4-methylenedioxy-N-methylamphetamine (ecstasy); amphetamine and amphetamine-like substances such as methylphenidate, other stimulants including caffeine and nicotine.
- Addictive substances which come particularly into consideration are opioids, cocaine, amphetamine or amphetamine-like substances, nicotine and alcohol.
- addiction disorders include alcohol abuse, cocaine abuse, tobacco abuse and smoking cessation.
- Examples of gastrointestinal disorders are irritable bowel syndrome.
- the disorders are selected from the group consisting of bipolar disorder, depression, atypical depression, mood episodes, adjustment disorders, anxiety, panic disorders, post-traumatic syndrome, psychoses, schizophrenia, cognitive deficits of schizophrenia, memory loss, dementia of aging, Alzheimer's disease, neuropsychiatric symptoms in Alzheimer's disease (e.g.
- Parkinson's disease behavioral disorders associated with dementia, social phobia, mental disorders in childhood, attention deficit hyperactivity disorder, organic mental disorders, autism, mutism, disruptive behavior disorder, impulse control disorder, borderline personality disorder, obsessive compulsive disorder, migraine and other conditions associated with cephalic pain or other pain, raised intracranial pressure, seizure disorders, epilepsy, substance use disorders, alcohol abuse, cocaine abuse, tobacco abuse, smoking cessation, sexual dysfunction/erectile dysfunction in males, sexual dysfunction in females, premenstrual syndrome, late luteal phase syndrome, chronic fatigue syndrome, sleep disorders, sleep apnoea, chronic fatigue syndrome, psoriasis, Parkinson's disease, psychosis in Parkinson's disease, neuropsychiatric symptoms in Parkinson's disease (e.g.
- Lewy Body dementia neuropsychiatric symptoms in Lewy Body dementia (e.g. aggression), spinal cord injury, trauma, stroke, pain, bladder dysfunction/urinary incontinence, encephalitis, meningitis, eating disorders, obesity, bulimia, weight loss, anorexia nervosa, ocular hypertension, cardiovascular disorders, gastrointestinal disorders, diabetes insipidus, diabetes mellitus, type I diabetes, type II diabetes, type III diabetes, diabetes secondary to pancreatic diseases, diabetes related to steroid use, diabetes complications, hyperglycemia and insulin resistance, and are specifically schizophrenia, depression, bipolar disorders, obesity, substance use disorders, neuropsychiatric symptoms in Alzheimer's disease (e.g. aggression) or neuropsychiatric symptoms in Parkinson's disease (e.g. aggression).
- Lewy Body dementia e.g. aggression
- neuropsychiatric symptoms in Lewy Body dementia e.g. aggression
- spinal cord injury trauma, stroke, pain, bladder dysfunction/urinary incontinence,
- the compounds of the invention may be used for a preventive treatment (prophylaxis), in particular as relapse prophylaxis or phase prophylaxis, but are preferably used for a treatment in its proper sense (i.e. non-prophylactic), i.e. for the treatment of acute or chronic signs, symptoms and/or malfunctions.
- the treatment can be orientated symptomatically, for example as the suppression of symptoms. It can be effected over a short period, be orientated over the medium term or can be a long-term treatment, for example within the context of a maintenance therapy.
- the present invention relates to the use of a compound I as defined above or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof for preparing a medicament for preventing (the development of) a disease condition as described above and to a method for preventing (the development of) a disease condition as described above comprises administering to the subject in need of treatment thereof (e.g., a mammal, such as a human) a therapeutically effective amount of a compound I as defined above or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
- a mammal such as a human
- the term “prevent” a disease condition by administration of any of the compounds described herein means that the detectable physical characteristics or symptoms of the disease or condition do not develop following the administration of the compound described herein.
- the method comprises administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound I as defined above or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, in combination with a therapeutically effective amount of at least one cognitive enhancing drug.
- the present invention relates to the use a compound I as defined above or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof for preparing a medicament for preventing the progression (e.g., worsening) of a disease condition and to a method for preventing the progression (e.g., worsening) of a disease condition, which method comprises administering to the subject in need of treatment thereof (e.g., a mammal, such as a human) a therapeutically effective amount of a compound I as defined above or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
- a mammal such as a human
- 5-HT 2C agonists or partial agonists would have therapeutic use in a variety of diseases, disorders and conditions.
- Knockout mice models lacking the 5-HT 2C receptor exhibit hyperphagia, obesity and are more prone to seizures and sudden death [Tecott L H, Sun L M, Akana S F, Strack A M, Lowenstein D H, Dallman M F, Julius D (1995) Eating disorder and epilepsy in mice lacking 5-HT 2C serotonin receptors. Nature 374:542-546]. They also exhibit compulsive-like behavior [Chou-Green J M, Holscher T D, Dallman M F, Akana S F (2003). Compulsive behavior in the 5-HT 2C receptor knockout mouse. Phys. Behav.
- 5-HT 2C is unique among other G-protein-coupled receptors (GPCRs) in that its pre-mRNA is a substrate for base modification via hydrolytic deamination of adenosines to yield inosines.
- GPCRs G-protein-coupled receptors
- Five adenosines, located within a sequence encoding the putative second intracellular domain can be converted to inosines.
- This editing can alter the coding potential of the triplet codons and allows for the generation of multiple different receptor isoforms.
- the edited receptor isoforms were shown to have reduced ability to interact with G-proteins in the absence of agonist stimulation [Werry, T D, Loiacono R, Sexton P A, Christopoulos A (2008). RNA editing of the serotonin 5-HT 2C receptor and its effects on cell signaling, pharmacology and brain function. Pharmac. Therap. 119:7-23].
- selective 5-HT 2C receptor agonists produce antidepressant effects in animal models of depression comparable to those of SSRIs but with a much faster onset of action and a therapeutic window that avoids antidepressant-induced sexual dysfunction.
- These agonists were also effective in animal models of compulsive behavior such as scheduled induced polydipsia and they also exhibited decreased hyperactivity and aggression in rodents [Rosenzweig-Lipson S, Sabb A, Stack G, Mitchell P, Lucki I, Malberg J E, Grauer S, Brennan J, Cryan J F, Sukoff Rizzo S J, Dunlop J, Barrett J E, Marquis K L (2007) Antidepressant-like effects of the novel, selective, 5-HT 2C receptor agonist WAY-163909 in rodents.
- Acute or chronic administration of 5-HT 2C agonists decreases the firing rate of ventral tegmental area dopamine neurons but not that of substantia nigra.
- 5-HT 2C agonists reduce dopamine levels in the nucleus accumbens but not in the striatum (the region of the brain mostly associated with extrapyramidal side effects) [Di Matteo, V., Di Giovanni, G., Di Mascio, M., & Esposito, E. (1999).
- SB 242084 a selective serotonin 2C receptor antagonist, increases dopaminergic transmission in the mesolimbic system. Neuropharmacology 38, 1195-1205.
- 5-HT 2C receptor agonists will selectively decrease mesolimibic dopamine levels without affecting the nigrostriatal pathway thus avoiding the EPS side effects of typical antipsychotics.
- 5-HT 2C receptor agonists have shown antipsychotic activity in animal models of schizophrenia without EPS based on the lack of effect in catalepsy [Marquis K L, Sabb A L, Logue S F, Brennan J A, Piesla M J, Comery T A, Grauer S M, Ashby C R, Jr., Nguyen H Q, Dawson L A, Barrett J E, Stack G, Meltzer H Y, Harrison B L, Rosenzweig-Lipson S (2007) WAY-163909 [(7bR,10aR)-1,2,3,4,8,9,10,10a-octahydro-7bH-cyclopenta-[b][1,4]diazepino[6,7,1hi]indole]: A novel 5-hydroxytryptamine 2C receptor-selective agonist with preclinical antipsychotic-like activity.
- 5-HT 2C receptor agonists without EPS coupled with their beneficial effects in mood disorders and cognition and their antiobesity like effects render 5-HT 2C receptor agonists as unique agents to treat schizophrenia [Rosenzweig-Lipson S, Dunlop J, Marquis K L (2007) 5-HT 2C receptor agonists as an innovative approach for psychiatric disorders. Drug news Perspect, 20: 565-571. Dunlop J, Marquis K L, Lim H K, Leung L, Kao J, Cheesman C, Rosenzweig-Lipson S (2006). Pharmacological profile of the 5-HT 2C receptor agonist WAY-163909; therapeutic potential in multiple indications. CNS Dug Rev. 12:167-177.].
- 5-HT 2C modulation has been implicated in epilepsy [Isaac M (2005). Serotonergic 5-HT 2C receptors as a potential therapeutic target for the antiepileptic drugs. Curr. Topics Med. Chem. 5:59:67], psoriasis [Thorslund K, Nordlind K (2007). Serotonergic drugs-a possible role in the treatment of psoriasis? Drug News Perspect 20:521-525], Parkinson's disease and related motor disorders [Esposito E, Di Matteo V, Pierucci M, Benigno A, Di Giavanni, G (2007). Role of central 5-HT 2C receptor in the control of basal ganglia functions.
- 5HT modulation can be useful in the treatment of pain, both neuropathic and nociceptive pain, see for example U.S. Patent application publication US2007/0225277.
- European Journal of Pharmacology (2007), 567(1-2), 89-94 Serotonin 2C receptor mRNA editing neuropathic pain model.
- Modulation of 5HT2 receptors may be beneficial in the treatment of conditions related to bladder function, in particular, urinary incontinence.
- urinary incontinence Discovery of a novel azepine series of potent and selective 5-HT2C agonists as potential treatments for urinary incontinence.
- 5-HT 2C agonists could be useful for the treatment of a number of psychiatric diseases, including schizophrenia, bipolar disorders, depression/anxiety, substance use disorders and especially disorders like neuropsychiatric symptoms in Alzheimer's disease: Aggression, psychosis/agitation represent key unmet medical needs.
- Clinical (Shen JHQ et al., A 6-week randomized, double-blind, placebo-controlled, comparator referenced trial of vabicaserin in acute schizophrenia. Journal of Psychiatric Research 53 (2014) 14-22; Liu J et al., Prediction of Efficacy of Vabicaserin, a 5-HT 2C Agonist, for the Treatment of Schizophrenia Using a Quantitative Systems Pharmacology Model.
- an effective quantity of one or more compounds is administered to the individual to be treated, preferably a mammal, in particular a human being, productive animal or domestic animal. Whether such a treatment is indicated, and in which form it is to take place, depends on the individual case and is subject to medical assessment (diagnosis) which takes into consideration signs, symptoms and/or malfunctions which are present, the risks of developing particular signs, symptoms and/or malfunctions, and other factors.
- diagnosis medical assessment
- compositions of the present invention can be varied so as to obtain an amount of the active compound(s) that is effective to achieve the desired therapeutic response for a particular subject (e.g., a mammal, preferably, a human (patient)), compositions and mode of administration.
- the selected dosage level will depend upon the activity of the particular compound, the route of administration, the severity of the condition being treated and the condition and prior medical history of the patient being treated. However, it is within the skill of the art to start doses of the compound at levels lower than required to achieve the desired therapeutic effect and to gradually increase the dosage until the desired effect is achieved.
- Compounds of the present invention can also be administered to a subject as a pharmaceutical composition comprising the compounds of interest in combination with at least one pharmaceutically acceptable carriers.
- the phrase “therapeutically effective amount” of the compound of the present invention means a sufficient amount of the compound to treat disorders, at a reasonable benefit/risk ratio applicable to any medical treatment. It will be understood, however, that the total daily usage of the compounds and compositions of the present invention will be decided by the attending physician within the scope of sound medical judgment.
- the specific therapeutically effective dose level for any particular patient will depend upon a variety of factors including the disorder being treated and the severity of the disorder; activity of the specific compound employed; the specific composition employed; the age, body weight, general health, sex and diet of the patient; the time of administration, route of administration, and rate of excretion of the specific compound employed; the duration of the treatment; drugs used in combination or coincidental with the specific compound employed; and like factors well-known in the medical arts. For example, it is well within the skill of the art to start doses of the compound at levels lower than required to achieve the desired therapeutic effect and to gradually increase the dosage until the desired effect is achieved.
- the total daily dose of the compounds of this invention administered to a subject ranges from about 0.01 mg/kg body weight to about 100 mg/kg body weight. More preferable doses can be in the range of from about 0.01 mg/kg body weight to about 30 mg/kg body weight. If desired, the effective daily dose can be divided into multiple doses for purposes of administration. Consequently, single dose compositions may contain such amounts or submultiples thereof to make up the daily dose.
- the present invention provides pharmaceutical compositions.
- the pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention comprise the compounds of the present invention or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or solvate thereof.
- the pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention comprise compounds of the present invention that can be formulated together with at least one non-toxic pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
- the present invention provides a pharmaceutical composition
- a pharmaceutical composition comprising compounds of the present invention or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, alone or in combination with one or more compounds that are not the compounds of the present invention.
- one or more compounds that can be combined with the compounds of the present invention in pharmaceutical compositions include, but are not limited to, one or more cognitive enhancing drugs.
- compositions of this present invention can be administered to a subject (e.g., a mammal, such as a human) orally, rectally, parenterally, intracisternally, intravaginally, intraperitoneally, topically (as by powders, ointments or drops), bucally or as an oral or nasal spray.
- a subject e.g., a mammal, such as a human
- parenterally intracisternally, intravaginally, intraperitoneally, topically (as by powders, ointments or drops), bucally or as an oral or nasal spray.
- parenterally refers to modes of administration which include intravenous, intramuscular, intraperitoneal, intrasternal, subcutaneous and intraarticular injection and infusion.
- pharmaceutically acceptable carrier means a nontoxic, inert solid, semi-solid or liquid filler, diluent, encapsulating material or formulation auxiliary of any type.
- materials which can serve as pharmaceutically acceptable carriers are sugars such as, but not limited to, lactose, glucose and sucrose; starches such as, but not limited to, corn starch and potato starch; cellulose and its derivatives such as, but not limited to, sodium carboxymethyl cellulose, ethyl cellulose and cellulose acetate; powdered tragacanth; malt; gelatin; talc; excipients such as, but not limited to, cocoa butter and suppository waxes; oils such as, but not limited to, peanut oil, cottonseed oil, safflower oil, sesame oil, olive oil, corn oil and soybean oil; glycols; such a propylene glycol; esters such as, but not limited to, ethyl oleate and e
- compositions of the present invention for parenteral injection comprise pharmaceutically acceptable sterile aqueous or nonaqueous solutions, dispersions, suspensions or emulsions as well as sterile powders for reconstitution into sterile injectable solutions or dispersions just prior to use.
- suitable aqueous and nonaqueous carriers, diluents, solvents or vehicles include water, ethanol, polyols (such as glycerol, propylene glycol, polyethylene glycol and the like), vegetable oils (such as olive oil), injectable organic esters (such as ethyl oleate) and suitable mixtures thereof.
- Proper fluidity can be maintained, for example, by the use of coating materials such as lecithin, by the maintenance of the required particle size in the case of dispersions and by the use of surfactants.
- compositions may also contain adjuvants such as preservatives, wetting agents, emulsifying agents and dispersing agents.
- adjuvants such as preservatives, wetting agents, emulsifying agents and dispersing agents.
- Prevention of the action of microorganisms can be ensured by the inclusion of various antibacterial and antifungal agents, for example, paraben, chlorobutanol, phenol sorbic acid and the like. It may also be desirable to include isotonic agents such as sugars, sodium chloride and the like.
- Prolonged absorption of the injectable pharmaceutical form can be brought about by the inclusion of agents which delay absorption such as aluminum monostearate and gelatin.
- the absorption of the drug in order to prolong the effect of the drug, it is desirable to slow the absorption of the drug from subcutaneous or intramuscular injection. This can be accomplished by the use of a liquid suspension of crystalline or amorphous material with poor water solubility. The rate of absorption of the drug then depends upon its rate of dissolution which, in turn, may depend upon crystal size and crystalline form. Alternatively, delayed absorption of a parenterally administered drug form is accomplished by dissolving or suspending the drug in an oil vehicle.
- Injectable depot forms are made by forming microencapsule matrices of the drug in biodegradable polymers such as polylactide-polyglycolide. Depending upon the ratio of drug to polymer and the nature of the particular polymer employed, the rate of drug release can be controlled. Examples of other biodegradable polymers include poly(orthoesters) and poly(anhydrides). Depot injectable formulations are also prepared by entrapping the drug in liposomes or microemulsions which are compatible with body tissues.
- the injectable formulations can be sterilized, for example, by filtration through a bacterial-retaining filter or by incorporating sterilizing agents in the form of sterile solid compositions which can be dissolved or dispersed in sterile water or other sterile injectable medium just prior to use.
- Solid dosage forms for oral administration include capsules, tablets, pills, powders and granules.
- the active compound may be mixed with at least one inert, pharmaceutically acceptable excipient or carrier, such as sodium citrate or dicalcium phosphate and/or a) fillers or extenders such as starches, lactose, sucrose, glucose, mannitol and silicic acid; b) binders such as carboxymethylcellulose, alginates, gelatin, polyvinylpyrrolidone, sucrose and acacia; c) humectants such as glycerol; d) disintegrating agents such as agar-agar, calcium carbonate, potato or tapioca starch, alginic acid, certain silicates and sodium carbonate; e) solution retarding agents such as paraffin; f) absorption accelerators such as quaternary ammonium compounds; g) wetting agents such as cetyl alcohol and glycerol monostearate; h)
- compositions of a similar type may also be employed as fillers in soft and hard-filled gelatin capsules using such carriers as lactose or milk sugar as well as high molecular weight polyethylene glycols and the like.
- the solid dosage forms of tablets, dragees, capsules, pills and granules can be prepared with coatings and shells such as enteric coatings and other coatings well-known in the pharmaceutical formulating art. They may optionally contain opacifying agents and may also be of a composition such that they release the active ingredient(s) only, or preferentially, in a certain part of the intestinal tract, optionally, in a delayed manner.
- coatings and shells such as enteric coatings and other coatings well-known in the pharmaceutical formulating art. They may optionally contain opacifying agents and may also be of a composition such that they release the active ingredient(s) only, or preferentially, in a certain part of the intestinal tract, optionally, in a delayed manner.
- embedding compositions which can be used include polymeric substances and waxes.
- the active compounds can also be in micro-encapsulated form, if appropriate, with one or more of the above-mentioned carriers.
- Liquid dosage forms for oral administration include pharmaceutically acceptable emulsions, solutions, suspensions, syrups and elixirs.
- the liquid dosage forms may contain inert diluents commonly used in the art such as, for example, water or other solvents, solubilizing agents and emulsifiers such as ethyl alcohol, isopropyl alcohol, ethyl carbonate, ethyl acetate, benzyl alcohol, benzyl benzoate, propylene glycol, 1,3-butylene glycol, dimethyl formamide, oils (in particular, cottonseed, groundnut, corn, germ, olive, castor and sesame oils), glycerol, tetrahydrofurfuryl alcohol, polyethylene glycols and fatty acid esters of sorbitan and mixtures thereof.
- inert diluents commonly used in the art such as, for example, water or other solvents, solubilizing agents and emulsifiers such as
- the oral compositions may also include adjuvants such as wetting agents, emulsifying and suspending agents, sweetening, flavoring and perfuming agents.
- adjuvants such as wetting agents, emulsifying and suspending agents, sweetening, flavoring and perfuming agents.
- Suspensions in addition to the active compounds, may contain suspending agents as, for example, ethoxylated isostearyl alcohols, polyoxyethylene sorbitol and sorbitan esters, microcrystalline cellulose, aluminum metahydroxide, bentonite, agar-agar, tragacanth and mixtures thereof.
- suspending agents as, for example, ethoxylated isostearyl alcohols, polyoxyethylene sorbitol and sorbitan esters, microcrystalline cellulose, aluminum metahydroxide, bentonite, agar-agar, tragacanth and mixtures thereof.
- compositions for rectal or vaginal administration are preferably suppositories which can be prepared by mixing the compounds of this invention with suitable non-irritating carriers or carriers such as cocoa butter, polyethylene glycol or a suppository wax which are solid at room temperature but liquid at body temperature and therefore melt in the rectum or vaginal cavity and release the active compound.
- suitable non-irritating carriers or carriers such as cocoa butter, polyethylene glycol or a suppository wax which are solid at room temperature but liquid at body temperature and therefore melt in the rectum or vaginal cavity and release the active compound.
- Liposomes are generally derived from phospholipids or other lipid substances. Liposomes are formed by mono- or multi-lamellar hydrated liquid crystals which are dispersed in an aqueous medium. Any non-toxic, physiologically acceptable and metabolizable lipid capable of forming liposomes can be used.
- the present compositions in liposome form can contain, in addition to a compound of the present invention, stabilizers, preservatives, excipients and the like.
- the preferred lipids are natural and synthetic phospholipids and phosphatidyl cholines (lecithins) used separately or together.
- Dosage forms for topical administration of a compound of the present invention include powders, sprays, ointments and inhalants.
- the active compound may be mixed under sterile conditions with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier and any needed preservatives, buffers or propellants which may be required.
- Ophthalmic formulations, eye ointments, powders and solutions are also contemplated as being within the scope of this invention.
- the compounds of the present invention can be used in the form of pharmaceutically acceptable salts derived from inorganic or organic acids.
- pharmaceutically acceptable salt means those salts which are, within the scope of sound medical judgment, suitable for use in contact with the tissues of humans and lower animals without undue toxicity, irritation, allergic response and the like and are commensurate with a reasonable benefit/risk ratio.
- salts are well known in the art. For example, S. M. Berge et al. describe pharmaceutically acceptable salts in detail in ( J. Pharmaceutical Sciences, 1977, 66: 1 et seq.).
- the salts can be prepared in situ during the final isolation and purification of the compounds of the invention or separately by reacting a free base function with a suitable organic acid.
- Representative acid addition salts include, but are not limited to acetate, adipate, alginate, citrate, aspartate, benzoate, benzenesulfonate, bisulfate, butyrate, camphorate, camphorsulfonate, digluconate, glycerophosphate, hemisulfate, heptanoate, hexanoate, fumarate, hydrochloride, hydrobromide, hydroiodide, 2-hydroxyethansulfonate (isothionate), lactate, malate, maleate, methanesulfonate, nicotinate, 2-naphthalenesulfonate, oxalate, palmitoate, pectinate, persulfate, 3-phenylpropionate, picrate, pivalate, propionate, succinate, tartrate, thiocyanate, phosphate, glutamate, bicarbonate, p-toluenesulfonate and undecan
- the basic nitrogen-containing groups can be quaternized with such agents as lower alkyl halides such as, but not limited to, methyl, ethyl, propyl, and butyl chlorides, bromides and iodides; dialkyl sulfates like dimethyl, diethyl, dibutyl and diamyl sulfates; long chain halides such as, but not limited to, decyl, lauryl, myristyl and stearyl chlorides, bromides and iodides; arylalkyl halides like benzyl and phenethyl bromides and others. Water or oil-soluble or dispersible products are thereby obtained.
- lower alkyl halides such as, but not limited to, methyl, ethyl, propyl, and butyl chlorides, bromides and iodides
- dialkyl sulfates like dimethyl, diethyl, dibutyl and diamyl
- acids which can be employed to form pharmaceutically acceptable acid addition salts include such inorganic acids as hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, sulfuric acid, and phosphoric acid and such organic acids as acetic acid, fumaric acid, maleic acid, 4-methylbenzenesulfonic acid, succinic acid and citric acid.
- Basic addition salts can be prepared in situ during the final isolation and purification of compounds of this invention by reacting a carboxylic acid-containing moiety with a suitable base such as, but not limited to, the hydroxide, carbonate or bicarbonate of a pharmaceutically acceptable metal cation or with ammonia or an organic primary, secondary or tertiary amine.
- a suitable base such as, but not limited to, the hydroxide, carbonate or bicarbonate of a pharmaceutically acceptable metal cation or with ammonia or an organic primary, secondary or tertiary amine.
- Pharmaceutically acceptable salts include, but are not limited to, cations based on alkali metals or alkaline earth metals such as, but not limited to, lithium, sodium, potassium, calcium, magnesium and aluminum salts and the like and nontoxic quaternary ammonia and amine cations including ammonium, tetramethylammonium, tetraethylammonium, methylammonium, dimethylammonium, trimethylammonium, triethylammonium, diethylammonium, ethylammonium and the like.
- Other representative organic amines useful for the formation of base addition salts include ethylenediamine, ethanolamine, diethanolamine, piperidine, piperazine and the like.
- the compounds of the present invention can exist in unsolvated as well as solvated forms, including hydrated forms, such as hemi-hydrates.
- solvated forms including hydrated forms, such as hemi-hydrates.
- pharmaceutically acceptable solvents such as water and ethanol among others are equivalent to the unsolvated forms for the purposes of the invention.
- the compounds were either characterized via proton-NMR in d 6 -dimethylsulfoxide, d-chloroform or d 4 -methanol on a 400 MHz, 500 MHz or 600 MHz NMR instrument (Bruker AVANCE), or by 13 C-NMR at 125 MHz, or by 19 F-NMR at 470 MHz, or by mass spectrometry, generally recorded via HPLC-MS in a fast gradient on C18-material (electrospray-ionisation (ESI) mode).
- ESI electrospray-ionisation
- the magnetic nuclear resonance spectral properties refer to the chemical shifts ( ⁇ ) expressed in parts per million (ppm).
- the relative area of the shifts in the 1 H-NMR spectrum corresponds to the number of hydrogen atoms for a particular functional type in the molecule.
- the nature of the shift, as regards multiplicity, is indicated as singlet(s), broad singlet (s.
- Enantiomers were separated/purified by chiral supercritical fluid chromatography (SFC) (method A).
- Analytical samples were run on an Agilent 1260 Infinity Hybrid SFC System, controlled by Agilent OpenLab CDS ChemStation Edition.
- the system consists of an injector, a heated column compartment including a switch for 6 columns, a CO 2 -booster pump, a binary pump module for CO 2 and modifier flow and an UV-detector.
- the backpressure regulator was set to 160 bars and heated to 60° C. If not stated otherwise, the columns were 100 mm in length, 4.6 mm in diameter and packed with 5 ⁇ m material. They were kept at room temperature during analysis.
- As mobile phase a mixture of liquefied CO 2 and organic modifier with additive was used as indicated for each sample. The flow rate was kept at 3.5 mL/min.
- Preparative separations were carried out on a Waters Prep 100q SFC System, controlled by Waters MassLynx Software.
- the system consists of an open bed injector/collector, a heated column compartment including a switch for 6 columns, a CO 2 -booster pump, a pump module for modifier flow and an UV-detector.
- the gas liquid separator was driven with a make-up flow of 30 mL/min Methanol.
- the backpressure regulator was not to 120 bar and heated to 60° C. If not stated otherwise, the columns were 250 mm in length, 20 mm in diameter and packed with 5 ⁇ m material. They were kept at 30° C. during the separation.
- As mobile phase a mixture of liquefied CO 2 and organic modifier with additive was used as indicated for each sample. The flow rate was kept at 100 g/min.
- TPGS-750-M a surfactant composed of a lipophilic ⁇ -tocopherol moiety and a hydrophilic PEG-750-M chain, joined by a succinic acid linker; forms spontaneously micelles upon dissolution in water. From Sigma-Aldrich.). The mixture was stirred vigorously at ambient temperature for 48 h. The reaction mixture was then extracted with ethyl acetate. Then the organic phase was dried over MgSO 4 , filtrated and reduced under vacuum. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-10% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound (116 mg, 82% yield).
- the separation was carried out in two steps via method A.
- the retention time according to the method described above is 1.4 min.
- the retention time according to the method described above is 1.7 min.
- the aqueous phase was extracted three times with ethyl acetate and the combined organic phases were dried over Na 2 SO 4 , filtrated and concentrated in vacuum.
- the crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-30% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound.
- the organic phase was extracted three times with HCl (1M) and to the aqueous phase was added NaOH (1M) until pH 10 and was then extracted with dichloromethane three times.
- the organic phase was dried over MgSO 4 and reduced under vacuum.
- the crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-30% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound (1.68 mmol, 49%).
- the retention time according to the analytical method described above is 1.5 min and according to the preparative method described above is 4.6 min.
- the retention time according to the analytical method described above is 1.7 min and according to the preparative method described above is 5.1 min.
- the retention time according to the analytical method described above is 2.2 min and according to the preparative method described above is 6.6 min.
- the organic phase was extracted three times with HCl (1M) and to the aqueous phase was added NaOH (1M) until pH 10 and was then extracted with dichloromethane three times.
- the organic phase was dried over MgSO 4 and reduced under vacuum.
- the crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-30% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound (0.720 mmol, 55%).
- the mobile phase consisted of 93% CO 2 and 7% modifier.
- As modifier MeOH with 0.2 Vol % of aqueous ammonia solution (25%) was used.
- the mobile phase consisted of 93% CO2 and 7% modifier.
- modifier MeOH with 0.2 Vol % of aqueous ammonia solution (25%) was used.
- the retention time according to the analytical method described above is 2.5 min and according to the preparative method described above is 3.5 min.
- the organic phase was extracted three times with HCl (1M) and to the aqueous phase was added NaOH (1M) until pH 10 and was then extracted with dichloromethane three times.
- the organic phase was dried over MgSO 4 and reduced under vacuum.
- the crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-10% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound.
- tert-butyl 4-methyl-8-(((methylsulfonyl)oxy)methyl)-3,4,7,8-tetrahydro-1H-[1,4]diazepino[6,7,1-ij]quinoline-2(6H)-carboxylate (0.132 mmol, 1.00 eq) from step 7.2 dissolved in tert-butanol (2 mL) was added 80 mg of caesium fluoride (0.526, 4.00 eq). The mixture was heated for 2 h in a microwave at 80° C. Then saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution was added. The organic phase was separated from the aqueous phase and the aqueous phase was extracted with DCM. The organic phase was dried over MgSO 4 and reduced under vacuum to yield the title compound.
- the response produced was measured and compared with the response produced by 10 [mu]M 5-HT or the maximal effect induced by 5-HT (defined as 100%) to which it was expressed as a percentage response (relative efficacy).
- Functional activity on the 5-HT 2A receptor was determined by testing the effect of the compounds I on calcium mobilization in CHO-K1 cells, stably transfected with human 5-HT 2A receptor.
- Cells were seeded into sterile black 384-well plates with clear bottom at 25,000 cells/well in a volume of 25 ⁇ l and grown for 5-6 hours at 37° C., in 5% CO 2 in tissue culture medium (“Ultra CHO” by LONZA), containing 1% dialysed FCS and 50 ⁇ g/ml gentamicin (Invitrogen). After this incubation, medium was replaced by a serum free version of the same tissue culture medium followed by incubation overnight at 37° C. and in 5% CO 2 .
- Cells were then loaded with a fluorescent calcium-sensitive dye in the presence of 0.07% probenecid for an hour at 37° C., according to the manufacturer's protocol (Ca5-Assay Kit, Molecular Devices), followed by an additional 60 min incubation at room temperature.
- Functional activity on the 5-HT 2B receptor was determined by testing the effect of the compounds I on calcium mobilization in CHO-FlpIn cells, stably transfected with human 5-HT 2B receptor.
- Cells were seeded into sterile black 384-well plates with clear bottom at 30,000 cells/well in a volume of 25 ⁇ l and grown overnight at 37° C., in 5% CO 2 in tissue culture medium (“CHO-S-SFM II” by Invitrogen), containing 1% dialysed FCS and 50 ⁇ g/ml gentamicin (Invitrogen).
- tissue culture medium (“CHO-S-SFM II” by Invitrogen)
- FCS tissue culture medium
- 50 ⁇ g/ml gentamicin Invitrogen
- Cells were then loaded with a fluorescent calcium-sensitive dye in the presence of 0.07% probenecid for an hour at 37° C., according to the manufacturer's protocol (Ca5-Assay Kit, Molecular Devices), followed by an additional 60 min incubation at room temperature.
Landscapes
- Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
- Organic Chemistry (AREA)
- Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
- General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
- Public Health (AREA)
- Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
- Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
- Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
- Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
- Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
- Epidemiology (AREA)
- General Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
- Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
- Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
- Neurosurgery (AREA)
- Neurology (AREA)
- Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
- Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
- Biomedical Technology (AREA)
- Pharmaceuticals Containing Other Organic And Inorganic Compounds (AREA)
Abstract
The present invention relates to tricyclic hexahydrodiazepinoquinolines carrying a substituted alkyl radical, to a method for producing them, to a pharmaceutical composition containing such compounds, to their use as modulators, especially agonists or partial agonists, of the 5-HT2C receptor, their use for preparing a medicament for the prevention or treatment of conditions and disorders which respond to the modulation of 5-HT2C receptor, to a method for preventing or treating conditions and disorders which respond to the modulation of 5-HT2C receptor, and processes for preparing such compounds and compositions.
Description
- This claims priority to U.S. Provisional Patent Application No. 61/953,337, filed on Mar. 14, 2014, the entire contents of which are fully incorporated herein by reference.
- The present invention relates to tricyclic hexahydrodiazepinoquinolines carrying a substituted alkyl radical, to a method for producing them, to a pharmaceutical composition containing such compounds, to their use as modulators, especially agonists or partial agonists, of the 5-HT2C receptor, their use for preparing a medicament for the prevention or treatment of conditions and disorders which respond to the modulation of 5-HT2C receptor, to a method for preventing or treating conditions and disorders which respond to the modulation of 5-HT2C receptor, and processes for preparing such compounds and compositions.
- Diseases, disorders and conditions where 5-HT2C modulation is desired are for example depression, anxiety, schizophrenia, bipolar disorder, obsessive compulsive disorder, migraine, pain, epilepsy, substance abuse, eating disorders, obesity, diabetes, erectile dysfunction and others.
- Serotonin (5-hydroxytryptamine, 5-HT), a monoamine neurotransmitter and local hormone, is formed by the hydroxylation and decarboxylation of tryptophan. The greatest concentration is found in the enterochromaffin cells of the gastrointestinal tract, the remainder being predominantly present in platelets and in the Central Nervous System (CNS). 5-HT is implicated in a vast array of physiological and pathophysiological pathways. In the periphery, it contracts a number of smooth muscles and induces endothelium-dependent vasodilation. In the CNS, it is believed to be involved in a wide range of functions, including the control of appetite, mood, anxiety, hallucinations, sleep, vomiting and pain perception.
- Neurons that secrete 5-HT are termed serotonergic. The function of 5-HT is exerted upon its interaction with specific (serotonergic) neurons. Seven types of 5-HT receptors have been identified: 5-HT1 (with subtypes 5-HT1A, 5-HT1B, 5-HT1D, 5-HT1E and 5-HT1F), 5-HT2 (with subtypes 5-HT2A, 5-HT2B and 5-HT2C), 5-HT3, 5-HT4, 5-HT5 (with subtypes 5-HT5A and 5-HT5B), 5-HT6 and 5-HT7. Most of these receptors are coupled to G-proteins that affect the activities of adenylate cyclase or phospholipase Cγ.
- Alterations in the activity of multiple neurotransmitter receptor systems (dopamine, serotonin, glutamate, GABA, acetylcholine) have been implicated in the manifestation of the symptoms of schizophrenia. The most widely accepted “Dopamine Hypothesis of Schizophrenia” in its simplest form states that the positive symptoms of this pathology relate to a functional hyperactivity of the mesolimbic dopaminergic system, while the negative and cognitive aspects can be traced to a functional hypoactivity of the mesocortical dopaminergic projections. Atypical antipsychotics block the mesolimbic dopaminergic neurotransmission, thereby controlling positive symptoms, with little or no effect on the nigrostriatal system, leading to less induction of extrapyramidal side effects (EPS).
- Primary negative and cognitive symptoms of schizophrenia reflect a dysfunction of the frontal cortex (“hypofrontality”), which is thought to be induced by a decreased tone in the mesocortical dopaminergic projection field [Davis K L, Kahn R S, Ko G and Davidson M (1991). Dopamine in schizophrenia: a review and re-conceptualization. Am J Psychiatry 148: 1474-86. Weinberger D R and Berman K F (1996). Prefrontal function in schizophrenia: confounds and controversies. Philos Trans R Soc Lond B Biol Sci 351: 1495-503]. Agents that selectively enhance dopamine levels in the cortex have the potential to address the negative symptoms of this disorder. Atypical antipsychotics lack robust efficacy against negative and cognitive components of the schizophrenic syndrome.
- The schizophrenic symptomatology is further complicated by the occurrence of drug-induced so-called secondary negative symptoms and cognitive impairment, which are difficult to distinguish from primary negative and cognitive symptoms [Remington G and Kapur S (2000). Atypical antipsychotics: are some more atypical than others? Psychopharmacol 148: 3-15]. The occurrence of secondary negative symptoms not only limits therapeutic efficacy but also, together with these side effects, negatively affects patient compliance.
- It may thus be hypothesized that a novel mechanistic approach that blocks dopaminergic neurotransmission in the limbic system but does not affect the striatal and pituitary projection fields, and stimulates frontocortical projection fields, would provide an efficacious treatment for all parts of the schizophrenic pathology, including its positive, negative and cognitive symptoms. Moreover, a selective compound that is substantially free of the ancillary pharmacology that characterizes current agents would be expected to avoid a variety of off-target side effects that plague current treatments such as extrapyramidal side effects (EPS) and weight gain.
- The 5-HT2C receptor, previously named 5-HT1C, is a G-protein-coupled receptor, which couples to multiple cellular effector systems including the phospholipase C, A and D pathways. It is found primarily in the brain and its distribution is particularly high in the plexus choroideus, where it is assumed to control cerebrospinal fluid production [Kaufman M J, Hirata F (1996) Cyclic GMP inhibits phosphoinositide turnover in choroid plexus: evidence for interactions between second messengers concurrently triggered by 5-HT2C receptors. Neurosci Lett 206:153-156]. Very high levels were also found in the retrosplenial, piriform and entorhinal cortex, anterior olfactory nucleus, lateral septal nucleus, subthalamic nucleus, amygdala, subiculum and ventral part of CA3, lateral habenula, substantia nigra pars compacta, several brainstem nuclei and the whole grey matter of the spinal cord [Pompeiano M, Palacios J M, Mengod G (1994). Distribution of the serotonin 5-HT2 receptor family mRNAs: comparison between 5-HT2A and 5-HT2C receptors. Brain Res Mol Brain Res 23:163-178]. A comparison of the distribution of 5-HT2C mRNA with that of 5-HT2C protein in monkey and human brains has revealed both pre- and postsynaptic localization [Lopez-Gimenez J F, Mengod G, Palacios J M, Vilaro M T (2001) Regional distribution and cellular localization of 5-HT2C receptor mRNA in monkey brain: comparison with [3H]mesulergine binding sites and choline acetyltransferase mRNA. Synapse 42:12-26].
- It is anticipated that modulation of the 5-HT2C receptor will improve disorders such as depression, anxiety, schizophrenia, cognitive deficits of schizophrenia, obsessive compulsive disorder, bipolar disorder, neuropsychiatric symptoms in Parkinson' disease, in Alzheimer's disease or Lewy Body dementia, migraine, epilepsy, substance abuse, eating disorders, obesity, diabetes, sexual dysfunction/erectile dysfunction, sleep disorders, psoriasis, Parkinson's disease, pain conditions and disorders, and spinal cord injury, smoking cessation, ocular hypertension and Alzheimer's disease. Modulators of the 5-HT2C receptor are also shown to be useful in the modulation of bladder function, including the prevention or treatment of urinary incontinence.
- Compounds with a structure similar to the compounds of the present invention have been described in WO 2014/041131 and WO 03/091250.
- There is an ongoing need for providing compounds having high affinity and in particular also high selectivity for the 5-HT2C receptor. In particular the compounds should have low affinity to adrenergic receptors, such as the α1-adrenergic receptor, histamine receptors, such as the H1-receptor, and dopaminergic receptors, such as the D2-receptor, in order to avoid or reduce side effects associated with modulation of these receptors, such as postural hypotension, reflex tachycardia, potentiation of the antihypertensive effect of prazosin, terazosin, doxazosin and labetalol or dizziness associated with the blockade of the α1-adrenergic receptor, weight gain, sedation, drowsiness or potentiation of central depressant drugs associated with the blockade of the H1-receptor, or extrapyramidal movement disorder, such as dystonia, parkinsonism, akathisia, tardive dyskinesia or rabbit syndrome, or endocrine effects, such as prolactin elevation (galactorrhea, gynecomastia, mentstrual changes, sexual dysfunction in males), associated with the blockade of the D2-receptor, and even more important no induction of weight gain in combination with severe metabolic dysfunction found for marketed antipsychotic drugs.
- It is moreover desirable that the compounds have low affinity or alternatively an antagonistic effect to/on other serotonergic receptors, especially the 5-HT2A and/or 5-HT2B receptors, in order to avoid or reduce side effects associated with modulation of these receptors, such as changes (thickening) of the heart tissue associated with agonism at the 5-HT2B receptor, and psychotomimetic effect induced by agonism at the 5-HT2A receptor. Ideally they should show an agonistic action on the 5-HT2C receptor, an antagonistic action on the 5-HT2A receptor or alternatively no affinity to the 5-HT2A receptor and no affinity to the 5-HT2B receptor or alternatively an antagonistic action on the 5-HT2B receptor. Even more ideally the compounds should display an agonistic action on the 5-HT2C receptor in combination with an antagonistic action on the 5-HT2A receptor and no affinity to the 5-HT2B receptor.
- Besides the affinity and selectivity for the 5-HT2C receptor, further properties may be advantageous for the treatment and/or prophylaxis of 5-HT2C-related disorders, such as, for example:
- 1.) the metabolic stability, for example determined from the half-lives, measured in vitro, in liver microsomes from various species (e.g. rat or human);
- 2.) no or only low inhibition of cytochrome P450 (CYP) enzymes: cytochrome P450 (CYP) is the name for a superfamily of heme proteins having enzymatic activity (oxidase). They are also particularly important for the degradation (metabolism) of foreign substances such as drugs or xenobiotics in mammalian organisms. The principal representatives of the types and subtypes of CYP in the human body are: CYP 1A2, CYP 2C9, CYP 2D6 and CYP 3A4. If CYP 3A4 inhibitors (e.g. grapefruit juice, cimetidine, erythromycin) are used at the same time as medicinal substances which are degraded by this enzyme system and thus compete for the same binding site on the enzyme, the degradation thereof may be slowed down and thus effects and side effects of the administered medicinal substance may be undesirably enhanced;
- 3.) a suitable solubility in water (in mg/mL);
- 4.) suitable pharmacokinetics (time course of the concentration of the compound of the invention in plasma or in tissue, for example brain). The pharmacokinetics can be described by the following parameters: half-life (in h), volume of distribution (in 1·kg−1), plasma clearance (in 1·h−1·kg−1), AUC (area under the curve, area under the concentration-time curve, in ng·h·1−1), oral bioavailability (the dose-normalized ratio of AUC after oral administration and AUC after intravenous administration), the so-called brain-plasma ratio (the ratio of AUC in brain tissue and AUC in plasma);
- 5.) no or only low blockade of the hERG channel: compounds which block the hERG channel may cause a prolongation of the QT interval and thus lead to serious disturbances of cardiac rhythm (for example so-called “torsade de pointes”). The potential of compounds to block the hERG channel can be determined by means of the displacement assay with radiolabelled dofetilide which is described in the literature (G. J. Diaz et al., Journal of Pharmacological and Toxicological Methods, 50 (2004), 187 199). A smaller IC50 in this dofetilide assay means a greater probability of potent hERG blockade. In addition, the blockade of the hERG channel can be measured by electrophysiological experiments on cells which have been transfected with the hERG channel, by so-called whole-cell patch clamping (G. J. Diaz et al., Journal of Pharmacological and Toxicological Methods, 50 (2004), 187-199).
- It was an object of the present invention to provide compounds for the treatment or prophylaxis of various 5-HT2C-related diseases. The compounds were intended to have a high affinity on the 5-HT2C receptor and be potent and efficacious 5-HT2C agonists. In addition, the compounds of the invention were intended to have one or more of the aforementioned advantages, namely low affinity to other serotonergic receptors, and especially the lack of potent agonistic effect (antagonism preferred) on the 5-HT2A and/or 5-HT2B receptors, and additionally one or more of those advantages mentioned under 1.) to 5.).
- The present invention provides compounds which have an affinity for the 5-HT2C, thus allowing the treatment of disorders related to or affected by the 5-HT2C receptor.
- The present invention relates to tricyclic hexahydrodiazepinoquinolines carrying a substituted alkyl radical, to a method for producing them, to compositions comprising such compounds, their use as modulators, especially agonists or partial agonists, of the 5-HT2C receptor, their use for preparing a medicament for the prevention or treatment of conditions and disorders which respond to the modulation of 5-HT2C receptor, to a method for preventing or treating conditions and disorders which respond to the modulation of 5-HT2C receptor, and processes for preparing such compounds and compositions.
- In one aspect, the present invention relates to compounds of the formula (I):
- wherein
- R1 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, cyano, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C2-C6-alkenyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkenyl, C2-C6-alkynyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkynyl, C3-C8-cycloalkyl, fluorinated C3-C8-cycloalkyl, C1-C6-alkoxy, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy, —C(═O)R9, phenyl, phenyl-C1-C2-alkyl and a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated heterocyclic ring containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom groups independently selected from N, O, S, NO, SO and SO2 and optionally also 1 or 2 C═O and/or C═S groups as ring members, where the cyclic moieties in the three last-mentioned radicals may be substituted with one or more substituents R10;
- each R2 is independently selected from the group consisting of cyano, nitro, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C1-C6-hydroxyalkyl, C2-C6-alkenyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkenyl, C2-C6-alkynyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkynyl, C3-C8-cycloalkyl, fluorinated C3-C8-cycloalkyl, C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, —CH2NR11aR11b, —C(═O)R9, phenyl, phenyl-C1-C2-alkyl, and a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated ring containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom groups independently selected from N, O, S, NO, SO, SO2, C═O and C═S as ring members, where the cyclic moieties in the six last-mentioned radicals may be substituted with one or more substituents R10; or
- two radicals R2 bound to the same carbon atom, together with the carbon atom they are bound to, form a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated ring (i.e. a spiro-bound ring), where the ring may contain 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom-containing groups selected from O, S, N, SO, SO2, C═O and C═S as ring members, and where the ring may be substituted with one or more substituents R10;
- R3a and R3b, independently of each other, are selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, cyano, nitro, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C1-C6-hydroxyalkyl, C2-C6-alkenyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkenyl, C2-C6-alkynyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkynyl, C3-C8-cycloalkyl, fluorinated C3-C8-cycloalkyl, C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, —CH2NR11aR11b, —C(═O)R9, phenyl, phenyl-C1-C2-alkyl, and a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated ring containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom groups independently selected from N, O, S, NO, SO, SO2, C═O and C═S as ring members, where the cyclic moieties in the six last-mentioned radicals may be substituted with one or more substituents R10;
- R4a and R4b, independently of each other, are selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, cyano, nitro, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C1-C6-hydroxyalkyl, C2-C6-alkenyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkenyl, C2-C6-alkynyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkynyl, C3-C8-cycloalkyl, fluorinated C3-C8-cycloalkyl, C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, —CH2NR11aR11b, —C(═O)R9, phenyl, phenyl-C1-C2-alkyl, and a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated ring containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom groups independently selected from N, O, S, NO, SO, SO2, C═O and C═S as ring members, where the cyclic moieties in the six last-mentioned radicals may be substituted with one or more substituents R10; or
- R4a and R4b form together a group ═O or ═S; or
- R4a and R4b, together with the carbon atom they are bound to, form a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated ring (i.e. a spiro-bound ring), where the ring may contain 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom-containing groups selected from O, S, N, SO, SO2, C═O and C═S as ring members, and where the ring may be substituted with one or more substituents R10;
- R5a and R5b, independently of each other, are selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, cyano, nitro, hydroxyl, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C1-C6-hydroxyalkyl, C2-C6-alkenyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkenyl, C2-C6-alkynyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkynyl, C3-C8-cycloalkyl, fluorinated C3-C8-cycloalkyl, C1-C6-alkoxy, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy, C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, C1-C6-hydroxyalkoxy, C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkoxy, C1-C6-alkylthio, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylthio, C1-C6-alkylsulfinyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylsulfinyl, C1-C6-alkylsulfonyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylsulfonyl, —NR11aR11b, —CH2NR11aR11b, —NR11aC(O)R9, —C(═O)R9, SO2NR11aR11b, C1-C6-alkylcarbonyloxy, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylcarbonyloxy, phenyl, phenyl-C1-C2-alkyl, phenoxy, phenylsulfonyl, benzyloxy and a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated ring containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom groups independently selected from N, O, S, NO, SO, SO2, C═O and C═S as ring members, where the cyclic moieties in the six last-mentioned radicals may be substituted with one or more substituents R10; where
- R5a and R5b are not simultaneously hydroxyl; or
- R5a and R5b, together with the carbon atom they are bound to, form a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated ring (i.e. a spiro-bound ring), where the ring may contain 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom-containing groups selected from O, S, N, SO, SO2, C═O and C═S as ring members, and where the ring may be substituted with one or more substituents R10;
- R6 C1-C6-alkyl which carries one or more substituents R8;
- each R7 is independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, cyano, nitro, hydroxyl, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C1-C6-hydroxyalkyl, C2-C6-alkenyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkenyl, C2-C6-alkynyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkynyl, C3-C8-cycloalkyl, fluorinated C3-C8-cycloalkyl, C3-C8-cycloalkenyl, fluorinated C3-C8-cycloalkenyl, C1-C6-alkoxy, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy, C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, C1-C6-hydroxyalkoxy, C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkoxy, C1-C6-alkylthio, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylthio, C1-C6-alkylsulfinyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylsulfinyl, C1-C6-alkylsulfonyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylsulfonyl, —NR11aR11b, —CH2NR11aR11b, —NR11aC(O)R9, —C(═O)R9, SO2NR11aR11b, C1-C6-alkylcarbonyloxy, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylcarbonyloxy, phenyl, phenyl-C1-C2-alkyl, phenoxy, phenylsulfonyl, benzyloxy and a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated ring containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom groups independently selected from N, O, S, NO, SO, SO2, C═O and C═S as ring members, where the cyclic moieties in the six last-mentioned radicals may be substituted with one or more substituents R10; or
- two radicals R7 bound on neighboring carbon atoms, together with the carbon atoms they are bound to, form a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated ring, where the ring may contain 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom-containing groups selected from O, S, N, SO, SO2, C═O and C═S as ring members, and where the ring may be substituted with one or more substituents R10;
- each R8 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxyl, halogen, C1-C6-alkoxy, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy, C1-C6-hydroxyalkoxy, C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkoxy, C1-C6-alkylthio, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylthio, C1-C6-alkylsulfinyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylsulfinyl, C1-C6-alkylsulfonyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylsulfonyl and —NR11aR11b;
- each R9 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, cyano, hydroxyl, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C1-C6-hydroxyalkyl, C2-C6-alkenyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkenyl, C2-C6-alkynyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkynyl, C3-C8-cycloalkyl, fluorinated C3-C8-cycloalkyl, C1-C6-alkoxy, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy, —NR11aR11b, —CH2NR11aR11b, phenyl, phenyl-C1-C2-alkyl, phenoxy, benzyloxy and a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated ring containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom groups independently selected from N, O, S, NO, SO, SO2, C═O and C═S as ring members, where the cyclic moieties in the five last-mentioned radicals may be substituted with one or more substituents R10;
- each R10 is independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, cyano, nitro, hydroxyl, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C1-C6-hydroxyalkyl, C2-C6-alkenyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkenyl, C2-C6-alkynyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkynyl, C3-C8-cycloalkyl, fluorinated C3-C8-cycloalkyl, C1-C6-alkoxy, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy, C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, C1-C6-hydroxyalkoxy, C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkoxy, C1-C6-alkylthio, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylthio, C1-C6-alkylsulfinyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylsulfinyl, C1-C6-alkylsulfonyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylsulfonyl, —COOH, —NR11aR11b, —CH2NR11aR11b, C1-C6-alkylcarbonyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylcarbonyl, C1-C6-alkoxycarbonyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxycarbonyl, SO2NR11aR11b, C1-C6-alkylcarbonyloxy and fluorinated C1-C6-alkylcarbonyloxy;
- or two radicals R10, together with the atom(s) they are bound to, form a saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated 3-, 4-, 5-, 6- or 7-membered carbocyclic or heterocyclic ring, where the heterocyclic ring contains 1, 2 or 3 heteroatoms or heteroatom groups independently selected from N, O, S, NO, SO, SO2, C═O and C═S as ring members;
- R11a and R11b, independently of each other and independently of each occurrence, are selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, cyano, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C2-C6-alkenyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkenyl, C2-C6-alkynyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkynyl, C3-C8-cycloalkyl, fluorinated C3-C8-cycloalkyl, C1-C6-alkoxy, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy, C1-C6-alkylcarbonyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylcarbonyl, C1-C6-alkoxycarbonyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxycarbonyl, phenyl and benzyl, where the phenyl moieties in the two last-mentioned radicals may carry 1, 2 or 3 substituents selected from halogen, cyano nitro, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C1-C6-alkoxy and fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy; or,
- if R11a and R11b are bound to the same nitrogen atom, together with this nitrogen atom may form a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated heterocyclic ring, where the ring may further contain 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom-containing groups selected from O, S, N, SO, SO2, C═O and C═S as ring members, and where the ring may be substituted with one or more substituents selected from halogen, cyano nitro, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C1-C6-alkoxy and fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy;
- a is 0, 1 or 2; and
- b is 0, 1, 2 or 3;
- or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
- In another aspect, the invention relates to a pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount of at least one compound of formula I or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, in combination with at least one pharmaceutically acceptable carrier and/or auxiliary substance.
- In yet another aspect, the invention relates to a compound of formula I or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof for use as a medicament.
- In yet another aspect, the invention relates to a compound of formula I or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof for the treatment of disorders which responds to the modulation of the 5-HT2C receptor.
- In yet another aspect, the invention relates to the use of a compound of formula I or of an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof for the manufacture of a medicament for the treatment of disorders which respond to the modulation of the 5-HT2C receptor.
- In yet another aspect, the invention relates to the use of a compound of formula I or of an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof for the manufacture of a medicament for the treatment of disorders selected from the group consisting of damage of the central nervous system, disorders of the central nervous system, eating disorders, ocular hypertension, cardiovascular disorders, gastrointestinal disorders and diabetes, and especially from the group consisting of bipolar disorder, depression, atypical depression, mood episodes, adjustment disorders, anxiety, panic disorders, post-traumatic syndrome, psychoses, schizophrenia, cognitive deficits of schizophrenia, memory loss, dementia of aging, Alzheimer's disease, neuropsychiatric symptoms in Alzheimer's disease (e.g. aggression), behavioral disorders associated with dementia, social phobia, mental disorders in childhood, attention deficit hyperactivity disorder, organic mental disorders, autism, mutism, disruptive behavior disorder, impulse control disorder, borderline personality disorder, obsessive compulsive disorder, migraine and other conditions associated with cephalic pain or other pain, raised intracranial pressure, seizure disorders, epilepsy, substance use disorders, alcohol abuse, cocaine abuse, tobacco abuse, smoking cessation, sexual dysfunction/erectile dysfunction in males, sexual dysfunction in females, premenstrual syndrome, late luteal phase syndrome, chronic fatigue syndrome, sleep disorders, sleep apnoea, chronic fatigue syndrome, psoriasis, Parkinson's disease, neuropsychiatric symptoms in Parkinson's disease (e.g. aggression), Lewy Body dementia, neuropsychiatric symptoms in Lewy Body dementia (e.g. aggression), spinal cord injury, trauma, stroke, pain, bladder dysfunction/urinary incontinence, encephalitis, meningitis, eating disorders, obesity, bulimia, weight loss, anorexia nervosa, ocular hypertension, cardiovascular disorders, gastrointestinal disorders, diabetes insipidus, diabetes mellitus, type I diabetes, type II diabetes, type III diabetes, diabetes secondary to pancreatic diseases, diabetes related to steroid use, diabetes complications, hyperglycemia and insulin resistance.
- In yet another aspect, the invention relates to a method for treating disorders which respond to the modulation of the 5-HT2C receptor, which method comprises administering to a subject in need thereof at least one compound of formula I or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
- In yet another aspect, the invention relates to a method for treating disorders selected from the group consisting of damage of the central nervous system, disorders of the central nervous system, eating disorders, ocular hypertension, cardiovascular disorders, gastrointestinal disorders and diabetes, and especially from the group consisting of bipolar disorder, depression, atypical depression, mood episodes, adjustment disorders, anxiety, panic disorders, post-traumatic syndrome, psychoses, schizophrenia, cognitive deficits of schizophrenia, memory loss, dementia of aging, Alzheimer's disease, neuropsychiatric symptoms in Alzheimer's disease (e.g. aggression), behavioral disorders associated with dementia, social phobia, mental disorders in childhood, attention deficit hyperactivity disorder, organic mental disorders, autism, mutism, disruptive behavior disorder, impulse control disorder, borderline personality disorder, obsessive compulsive disorder, migraine and other conditions associated with cephalic pain or other pain, raised intracranial pressure, seizure disorders, epilepsy, substance use disorders, alcohol abuse, cocaine abuse, tobacco abuse, smoking cessation, sexual dysfunction/erectile dysfunction in males, sexual dysfunction in females, premenstrual syndrome, late luteal phase syndrome, chronic fatigue syndrome, sleep disorders, sleep apnoea, chronic fatigue syndrome, psoriasis, Parkinson's disease, neuropsychiatric symptoms in Parkinson's disease (e.g. aggression), Lewy Body dementia, neuropsychiatric symptoms in Lewy Body dementia (e.g. aggression), spinal cord injury, trauma, stroke, pain, bladder dysfunction/urinary incontinence, encephalitis, meningitis, eating disorders, obesity, bulimia, weight loss, anorexia nervosa, ocular hypertension, cardiovascular disorders, gastrointestinal disorders, diabetes insipidus, diabetes mellitus, type I diabetes, type II diabetes, type III diabetes, diabetes secondary to pancreatic diseases, diabetes related to steroid use, diabetes complications, hyperglycemia and insulin resistance, which method comprises administering to a subject in need thereof at least one compound of formula I or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
- The compounds of the formula I may exist in different spatial arrangements. For example, if the compounds possess one or more centers of asymmetry, polysubstituted rings or double bonds, or as different tautomers, the present invention contemplates the possible use of enantiomeric mixtures, in particular racemates, diastereomeric mixtures and tautomeric mixtures, such as the respective essentially pure enantiomers, diastereomers and tautomers of the compounds of formula I and/or their salts.
- It is likewise possible to use physiologically tolerated salts of the compounds of the formula I, especially acid addition salts with physiologically tolerated acids. Examples of suitable physiologically tolerated organic and inorganic acids are hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, phosphoric acid, sulfuric acid, acetic acid, trifluoroacetic acid, C1-C4-alkylsulfonic acids, such as methanesulfonic acid, aromatic sulfonic acids, such as benzenesulfonic acid and toluenesulfonic acid, oxalic acid, maleic acid, fumaric acid, lactic acid, tartaric acid, adipic acid and benzoic acid. Other utilizable acids are described in Fortschritte der Arzneimittelforschung [Advances in drug research], Volume 10, pages 224 et seq., Birkhäuser Verlag, Basel and Stuttgart, 1966.
- The compounds of formula I may also be present in the form of tautomers. In one aspect, tautomery may be present in compounds I wherein R4a and R4b form together a group ═O and R5a or R5b is H. For example, the compounds of formula I may have the following tautomeric formulae:
- In another aspect, tautomery may be present in compounds I containing rings which have one or more C═O groups as ring members which are neighboured to a CH2 group.
- The organic moieties mentioned in the above definitions of the variables are, like the term halogen, collective terms for individual listings of the individual group members. The prefix Cn-Cm indicates in each case the possible number of carbon atoms in the group.
- The term “halogen” denotes in each case fluorine, bromine, chlorine or iodine. In one aspect, the halogen may be fluorine, chlorine or bromine.
- The term “alkyl” as used herein and in the alkyl moieties of alkoxy, alkylthio, alkylsulfinyl, alkylsulfonyl, alkylcarbonyl, alkoxycarbonyl and the like refers to saturated straight-chain or branched hydrocarbon radicals having 1 to 2 (“C1-C2-alkyl”), 1 to 3 (“C1-C3-alkyl”), 1 to 4 (“C1-C4-alkyl”) or 1 to 6 (“C1-C6-alkyl”) carbon atoms. C1-C2-Alkyl is methyl or ethyl. C1-C3-Alkyl is additionally propyl and isopropyl. C1-C4-Alkyl is additionally butyl, 1-methylpropyl (sec-butyl), 2-methylpropyl (isobutyl) or 1,1-dimethylethyl (tert-butyl). C1-C6-Alkyl is additionally also, for example, pentyl, 1-methylbutyl, 2-methylbutyl, 3-methylbutyl, 2,2-dimethylpropyl, 1-ethylpropyl, 1,1-dimethylpropyl, 1,2-dimethylpropyl, hexyl, 1-methylpentyl, 2-methylpentyl, 3-methylpentyl, 4-methylpentyl, 1,1-dimethylbutyl, 1,2-dimethylbutyl, 1,3-dimethylbutyl, 2,2-dimethylbutyl, 2,3-dimethylbutyl, 3,3-dimethylbutyl, 1-ethylbutyl, 2-ethylbutyl, 1,1,2-trimethylpropyl, 1,2,2-trimethylpropyl, 1-ethyl-1-methylpropyl, or 1-ethyl-2-methylpropyl.
- The term “fluorinated alkyl” as used herein refers to straight-chain or branched alkyl groups having 1 (“fluorinated methyl), 1 to 2 (“fluorinated C1-C2-alkyl”), 1 to 3 (“fluorinated C1-C3-alkyl”), 1 to 4 (“fluorinated C1-C4-alkyl”) or 1 to 6 (“fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl”) carbon atoms (as mentioned above), where some or all of the hydrogen atoms in these groups are replaced by fluorine atoms. Fluorinated methyl is fluoromethyl, difluoromethyl or trifluoromethyl. Fluorinated C1-C2-alkyl is an alkyl group having 1 or 2 carbon atoms (as mentioned above), where at least one of the hydrogen atoms, e.g. 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5 hydrogen atoms in these groups are replaced by fluorine atoms, such as difluoromethyl, trifluoromethyl, 1-fluoroethyl, (R)-1-fluoroethyl, (S)-1-fluoroethyl, 2-fluoroethyl, 2,2-difluoroethyl, 2,2,2-trifluoroethyl, or pentafluoroethyl. Fluorinated C1-C4-alkyl is a straight-chain or branched alkyl group having 1 to 4 carbon atoms (as mentioned above), where at least one of the hydrogen atoms, e.g. 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5 hydrogen atoms in these groups are replaced by fluorine atoms. Examples are, apart those listed above for C1-C2-fluoroalkyl, 1-fluoropropyl, (R)-1-fluoropropyl, (S)-1-fluoropropyl, 2-fluoropropyl, (R)-2-fluoropropyl, (S)-2-fluoropropyl, 3-fluoropropyl, 1,1-difluoropropyl, 2,2-difluoropropyl, 1,2-difluoropropyl, 2,3-difluoropropyl, 1,3-difluoropropyl, 3,3-difluoropropyl, 1,1,2-trifluoropropyl, 1,2,2-trifluoropropyl, 1,2,3-trifluoropropyl, 2,2,3-trifluoropropyl, 3,3,3-trifluoropropyl, 1,1,1-trifluoroprop-2-yl, 2-fluoro-1-methylethyl, (R)-2-fluoro-1-methylethyl, (S)-2-fluoro-1-methylethyl, 2,2-difluoro-1-methylethyl, (R)-2,2-difluoro-1-methylethyl, (S)-2,2-difluoro-1-methylethyl, 1,2-difluoro-1-methylethyl, (R)-1,2-difluoro-1-methylethyl, (S)-1,2-difluoro-1-methylethyl, 2,2,2-trifluoro-1-methylethyl, (R)-2,2,2-trifluoro-1-methylethyl, (S)-2,2,2-trifluoro-1-methylethyl, 2-fluoro-1-(fluoromethyl)ethyl, 1-(difluoromethyl)-2,2-difluoroethyl, 1-(trifluoromethyl)-2,2,2-trifluoroethyl, 1-(trifluoromethyl)-1,2,2,2-tetrafluoroethyl, 1-fluorobutyl, (R)-1-fluorobutyl, (S)-1-fluorobutyl, 2-fluorobutyl, (R)-2-fluorobutyl, (S)-2-fluorobutyl, 3-fluorobutyl, (R)-3-fluorobutyl, (S)-3-fluorobutyl, 4-fluorobutyl, 1,1-difluorobutyl, 2,2-difluorobutyl, 3,3-difluorobutyl, 4,4-difluorobutyl, 4,4,4-trifluorobutyl and the like. Fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl is a straight-chain or branched alkyl group having 1 to 6 carbon atoms (as mentioned above), where at least one of the hydrogen atoms, e.g. 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5 hydrogen atoms in these groups are replaced by fluorine atoms. Additionally examples include for C1-C4-fluoroalkyl, 1-fluoropentyl, (R)-1-fluoropentyl, (S)-1-fluoropentyl, 2-fluoropentyl, (R)-2-fluoropentyl, (S)-2-fluoropentyl, 3-fluoropentyl, (R)-3-fluoropentyl, (S)-3-fluoropentyl, 4-fluoropentyl, (R)-4-fluoropentyl, (S)-4-fluoropentyl, 5-fluoropentyl, (R)-5-fluoropentyl, (S)-5-fluoropentyl, 1-fluorohexyl, (R)-1-fluorohexyl, (S)-1-fluorohexyl, 2-fluorohexyl, (R)-2-fluorohexyl, (S)-2-fluorohexyl, 3-fluorohexyl, (R)-3-fluorohexyl, (S)-3-fluorohexyl, 4-fluorohexyl, (R)-4-fluorohexyl, (S)-4-fluorohexyl, 5-fluorohexyl, (R)-5-fluorohexyl, (S)-5-fluorohexyl, 6-fluorohexyl, (R)-6-fluorohexyl, (S)-6-fluorohexyl, and the like.
- The term “haloalkyl” as used herein refers to straight-chain or branched alkyl groups having 1 to 2 (“C1-C2-haloalkyl”), 1 to 3 (“C1-C3-haloalkyl”), 1 to 4 (“C1-C4-haloalkyl”) or 1 to 6 (“C1-C6-haloalkyl”) carbon atoms (as mentioned above), where some or all of the hydrogen atoms in these groups are replaced by halogen atoms as mentioned above. Examples are, apart from those mentioned above for fluorinated alkyl, for C1-C2-haloalkyl chloromethyl, bromomethyl, dichloromethyl, trichloromethyl, chlorofluoromethyl, dichlorofluoromethyl, chlorodifluoromethyl, 1-chloroethyl, 1-bromoethyl, 2-chloro-2-fluoroethyl, 2-chloro-2,2-difluoroethyl, 2,2-dichloro-2-fluoroethyl or 2,2,2-trichloroethyl; for C1-C3-haloalkyl, apart those mentioned for C1-C2-haloalkyl, 3-chloropropyl; and for C1-C4-haloalkyl, apart those mentioned for C1-C3-haloalkyl, 4-chlorobutyl and the like.
- The term “alkenyl” as used herein refers to monounsaturated straight-chain or branched hydrocarbon radicals having 2 to 3 (“C2-C3-alkenyl”), 2 to 4 (“C2-C4-alkenyl”) or 2 to 6 (“C2-C6-alkenyl”) carbon atoms and a double bond in any position, such as C2-C3-alkenyl, such as ethenyl, 1-propenyl, 2-propenyl or 1-methylethenyl; C2-C4-alkenyl, such as ethenyl, 1-propenyl, 2-propenyl, 1-methylethenyl, 1-butenyl, 2-butenyl, 3-butenyl, 1-methyl -1-propenyl, 2-methyl -1-propenyl, 1-methyl-2-propenyl or 2-methyl-2-propenyl; and C2-C6-alkenyl, such as ethenyl, 1-propenyl, 2-propenyl, 1-methylethenyl, 1-butenyl, 2-butenyl, 3-butenyl, 1-methyl-1-propenyl, 2-methyl-1-propenyl, 1-methyl-2-propenyl, 2-methyl-2-propenyl, 1-pentenyl, 2-pentenyl, 3-pentenyl, 4-pentenyl, 1-methyl-1-butenyl, 2-methyl-1-butenyl, 3-methyl-1-butenyl, 1-methyl-2-butenyl, 2-methyl-2-butenyl, 3-methyl-2-butenyl, 1-methyl-3-butenyl, 2-methyl-3-butenyl, 3-methyl-3-butenyl, 1,1-dimethyl-2-propenyl, 1,2-dimethyl-1-propenyl, 1,2-dimethyl-2-propenyl, 1-ethyl-1-propenyl, 1-ethyl-2-propenyl, 1-hexenyl, 2-hexenyl, 3-hexenyl, 4-hexenyl, 5-hexenyl, 1-methyl-1-pentenyl, 2-methyl-1-pentenyl, 3-methyl-1-pentenyl, 4-methyl-1-pentenyl, 1-methyl-2-pentenyl, 2-methyl-2-pentenyl, 3-methyl-2-pentenyl, 4-methyl-2-pentenyl, 1-methyl-3-pentenyl, 2-methyl-3-pentenyl, 3-methyl-3-pentenyl, 4-methyl-3-pentenyl, 1-methyl-4-pentenyl, 2-methyl-4-pentenyl, 3-methyl-4-pentenyl, 4-methyl-4-pentenyl, 1,1-dimethyl-2-butenyl, 1,1-dimethyl-3-butenyl, 1,2-dimethyl-1-butenyl, 1,2-dimethyl-2-butenyl, 1,2-dimethyl-3-butenyl, 1,3-dimethyl-1-butenyl, 1,3-dimethyl-2-butenyl, 1,3-dimethyl-3-butenyl, 2,2-dimethyl-3-butenyl, 2,3-dimethyl-1-butenyl, 2,3-dimethyl-2-butenyl, 2,3-dimethyl-3-butenyl, 3,3-dimethyl-1-butenyl, 3,3-dimethyl-2-butenyl, 1-ethyl-1-butenyl, 1-ethyl-2-butenyl, 1-ethyl-3-butenyl, 2-ethyl-1-butenyl, 2-ethyl-2-butenyl, 2-ethyl-3-butenyl, 1,1,2-trimethyl-2-propenyl, 1-ethyl-1-methyl-2-propenyl, 1-ethyl-2-methyl-1-propenyl, 1-ethyl-2-methyl-2-propenyl and the like.
- The term “fluorinated alkenyl” as used herein refers to unsaturated straight-chain or branched hydrocarbon radicals having 2 to 3 (“fluorinated C2-C3-alkenyl”), 2 to 4 (“fluorinated C2-C4-alkenyl”) or 2 to 6 (“fluorinated C2-C6-alkenyl”) carbon atoms and a double bond in any position (as mentioned above), where some or all of the hydrogen atoms in these groups are replaced by fluorine atoms, such as, fluorovinyl, fluoroallyl and the like.
- The term “alkynyl” as used herein refers to straight-chain or branched hydrocarbon groups having 2 to 3 (“C2-C3-alkynyl”), 2 to 4 (“C2-C4-alkynyl”) or 2 to 6 (“C2-C6-alkynyl”) carbon atoms and one or two triple bonds in any position, such as C2-C3-alkynyl, such as ethynyl, 1-propynyl or 2-propynyl; C2-C4-alkynyl, such as ethynyl, 1-propynyl, 2-propynyl, 1-butynyl, 2-butynyl, 3-butynyl, 1-methyl-2-propynyl and the like, and C2-C6-alkynyl, such as ethynyl, 1-propynyl, 2-propynyl, 1-butynyl, 2-butynyl, 3-butynyl, 1-methyl-2-propynyl, 1-pentynyl, 2-pentynyl, 3-pentynyl, 4-pentynyl, 1-methyl-2-butynyl, 1-methyl-3-butynyl, 2-methyl-3-butynyl, 3-methyl-1-butynyl, 1,1-dimethyl-2-propynyl, 1-ethyl-2-propynyl, 1-hexynyl, 2-hexynyl, 3-hexynyl, 4-hexynyl, 5-hexynyl, 1-methyl-2-pentynyl, 1-methyl-3-pentynyl, 1-methyl-4-pentynyl, 2-methyl-3-pentynyl, 2-methyl-4-pentynyl, 3-methyl-1-pentynyl, 3-methyl-4-pentynyl, 4-methyl-1-pentynyl, 4-methyl-2-pentynyl, 1,1-dimethyl-2-butynyl, 1,1-dimethyl-3-butynyl, 1,2-dimethyl-3-butynyl, 2,2-dimethyl-3-butynyl, 3,3-dimethyl-1-butynyl, 1-ethyl-2-butynyl, 1-ethyl-3-butynyl, 2-ethyl-3-butynyl, 1-ethyl-1-methyl-2-propynyl and the like.
- The term “fluorinated alkynyl” as used herein refers to unsaturated straight-chain or branched hydrocarbon radicals having 2 to 3 (“fluorinated C2-C3-alkynyl”), 3 to 4 (“fluorinated C3-C4-alkynyl”) or 2 to 6 (“fluorinated C2-C6-alkynyl”) carbon atoms and one or two triple bonds in any position (as mentioned above), where some or all of the hydrogen atoms in these groups are replaced by fluorine atoms.
- The term “cycloalkyl” as used herein refers to monocyclic saturated hydrocarbon radicals having 3 to 8 (“C3-C8-cycloalkyl”), in particular 3 to 6 carbon atoms (“C3-C6-cycloalkyl”) or 3 to 5 carbon atoms (“C3-C5-cycloalkyl”) or 3 or 4 carbon atoms (“C3-C4-cycloalkyl”). Examples for C3-C4-cycloalkyl are cyclopropyl and cyclobutyl. Examples of C3-C5-cycloalkyl are cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl and cyclopentyl. Examples of C3-C6-cycloalkyl are cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl and cyclohexyl. Examples of C3-C8-cycloalkyl are cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, cycloheptyl and cyclooctyl.
- The term “fluorinated cycloalkyl” as used herein refers to monocyclic saturated hydrocarbon groups having 3 to 8 (“C3-C8-halocycloalkyl”) or preferably 3 to 6 (“C3-C6-halocycloalkyl”) or 3 to 5 (“C3-C5-halocycloalkyl”) carbon ring members (as mentioned above) in which some or all of the hydrogen atoms are replaced by fluorine atoms. Examples include 1-fluorocyclopropyl, 2-fluorocyclopropyl, (S)- and (R)-2,2-difluorocyclopropyl, 1,2-difluorocyclopropyl, 2,3-difluorocyclopropyl, pentafluorocyclopropyl, 1-fluorocyclobutyl, 2-fluorocyclobutyl, 3-fluorocyclobutyl, 2,2-difluorocyclobutyl, 3,3-difluorocyclobutyl, 1,2-difluorocyclobutyl, 1,3-difluorocyclobutyl, 2,3-difluorocyclobutyl, 2,4-difluorocyclobutyl, 1,2,2-trifluorocyclobutyl, 1-fluorocycloheptyl, 2-fluorocycloheptyl, 3-fluorocycloheptyl, 4-fluorocycloheptyl, 1,2-difluorocycloheptyl, 1,3-difluorocycloheptyl, 1,4-difluorocycloheptyl, 2,2-difluorocycloheptyl, 2,3-difluorocycloheptyl, 2,4-difluorocycloheptyl, 2,5-difluorocycloheptyl, 2,6-difluorocycloheptyl, 2,7-difluorocycloheptyl, 3,3-difluorocycloheptyl, 3,4-difluorocycloheptyl, 3,5-difluorocycloheptyl, 3,6-difluorocycloheptyl, 4,4-difluorocycloheptyl, 4,5-difluorocycloheptyl, and the like.
- The term “cycloalkenyl” as used herein refers to monocyclic partially unsaturated, non-aromatic hydrocarbon radicals having 3 to 8 (“C3-C8-cycloalkenyl”), in particular 5 to 7 carbon atoms (“C5-C7-cycloalkenyl”) or 5 or 6 carbon atoms (“C5-C6-cycloalkenyl”) and one or more non-cumulative, preferably one, C—C double bonds in the ring. Examples for C5-C6-cycloalkenyl are cyclopent-1-en-1-yl, cyclopent-1-en-3-yl, cyclopent-1-en-4-yl, cyclopenta-1,3-dien-1-yl, cyclopenta-1,3-dien-2-yl, cyclopenta-1,3-dien-5-yl, cyclohex-1-en-1-yl, cyclohex-1-en-3-yl, cyclohex-1-en-4-yl, cyclohexa-1,3-dien-1-yl, cyclohexa-1,3-dien-2-yl, cyclohexa-1,3-dien-5-yl, cyclohexa-1,4-dien-1-yl and cyclohexa-1,4-dien-3-yl. Examples of C5-C7-cycloalkenyl are, apart those mentioned above, include for C5-C6-cycloalkenyl, cyclohept-1-en-1-yl, cyclohept-1-en-3-yl, cyclohept-1-en-4-yl, cyclohept-1-en-5-yl, cyclohepta-1,3-dien-1-yl, cyclohepta-1,3-dien-2-yl, cyclohepta-1,3-dien-5-yl, cyclohepta-1,3-dien-6-yl, cyclohepta-1,4-dien-1-yl, cyclohepta-1,4-dien-2-yl, cyclohepta-1,4-dien-3-yl and cyclohepta-1,4-dien-6-yl. Examples of C3-C8-cycloalkenyl are, apart those mentioned above for C5-C6-cycloalkenyl, cycloprop-1-en-1-yl, cycloprop-1-en-3-yl, cyclobut-1-en-1-yl, cyclobut-1-en-3-yl, cyclooct-1-en-1-yl, cyclooct-1-en-3-yl, cyclooct-1-en-4-yl, cyclooct-1-en-5-yl, cycloocta-1,3-dien-1-yl, cycloocta-1,3-dien-2-yl, cycloocta-1,3-dien-5-yl, cycloocta-1,3-dien-6-yl, cycloocta-1,4-dien-1-yl, cycloocta-1,4-dien-2-yl, cycloocta-1,4-dien-3-yl, cycloocta-1,4-dien-6-yl, cycloocta-1,4-dien-7-yl, cycloocta-1,5-dien-1-yl, and cycloocta-1,5-dien-3-yl.
- The term “fluorinated cycloalkenyl” as used herein refers to monocyclic partially unsaturated, non-aromatic hydrocarbon radicals having 3 to 8 (“fluorinated C3-C8-cycloalkenyl”), in particular 5 to 7 carbon atoms (“fluorinated C5-C7-cycloalkenyl”) or 5 or 6 carbon atoms (“fluorinated C5-C6-cycloalkenyl”) and one or more non-cumulative, preferably one, C—C double bonds in the ring and in which some or all of the hydrogen atoms are replaced by fluorine atoms.
- The term “cycloalkyl-C1-C4-alkyl” refers to a C3-C8-cycloalkyl group (“C3-C8-cycloalkyl-C1-C4-alkyl”), preferably a C3-C6-cycloalkyl group (“C3-C6-cycloalkyl-C1-C4-alkyl”) as defined above which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a C1-C4alkyl group, as defined above. The term “cycloalkyl-C1-C2-alkyl” refers to a C3-C8-cycloalkyl group (“C3-C8-cycloalkyl-C1-C2-alkyl”), preferably a C3-C6-cycloalkyl group (“C3-C6-cycloalkyl-C1-C2-alkyl”) as defined above which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a C1-C2-alkyl group, as defined above. Examples for C3-C6-cycloalkyl-C1-C2-alkyl are cyclopropylmethyl, cyclopropylethyl, cyclobutylmethyl, cyclobutylethyl, cyclopentylmethyl, cyclopentylethyl, cyclohexylmethyl and cyclohexylethyl. Examples for C3-C6-cycloalkyl-C1-C4-alkyl, apart those mentioned for C3-C6-cycloalkyl-C1-C2-alkyl, are cyclopropylpropyl, cyclopropylbutyl, cyclobutylpropyl, cyclobutylbutyl, cyclopentylpropyl, cyclopentylbutyl, cyclohexylpropyl and cyclohexylbutyl. Examples for C3-C8-cycloalkyl-C1-C2-alkyl, apart those mentioned for C3-C6-cycloalkyl-C6-cycloalkyl-C1-C2-alkyl, are cycloheptylmethyl, cycloheptylethyl, cyclooctylmethyl and cyclooctylethyl. Examples for C3-C8-cycloalkyl-C1-C4-alkyl, apart those mentioned for C3-C8-cycloalkyl-C1-C2-alkyl, are cycloheptylpropyl, cycloheptylbutyl, cyclooctylpropyl and cyclooctylbutyl.
- The term “fluorinated cycloalkyl-C1-C4alkyl” refers to a fluorinated C3-C8-cycloalkyl group (“fluorinated C3-C8-cycloalkyl-C1-C4-alkyl”), preferably a fluorinated C3-C6-cycloalkyl group (“fluorinated C3-C6-cycloalkyl-C1-C4-alkyl”) as defined above which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a C1-C4-alkyl group, as defined above. The term “fluorinated cycloalkyl-C1-C2-alkyl” refers to a fluorinated C3-C8-cycloalkyl group (“fluorinated C3-C8-cycloalkyl-C1-C2-alkyl”), preferably a fluorinated C3-C6-cycloalkyl group (“fluorinated C3-C6-cycloalkyl-C1-C2-alkyl”) as defined above which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a C1-C2-alkyl group, as defined above.
- The term “C1-C2-alkoxy” is a C1-C2-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via an oxygen atom. The term “C1-C3-alkoxy” is a C1-C3-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via an oxygen atom. The term “C1-C4-alkoxy” is a C1-C4-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via an oxygen atom. The term “C1-C6-alkoxy” is a C1-C6-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via an oxygen atom. C1-C2-Alkoxy is methoxy or ethoxy. C1-C3-Alkoxy is additionally, for example, n-propoxy and 1-methylethoxy (isopropoxy). C1-C4-Alkoxy is additionally, for example, butoxy, 1-methylpropoxy (sec-butoxy), 2-methylpropoxy (isobutoxy) or 1,1-dimethylethoxy (tert-butoxy). C1-C6-Alkoxy is additionally, for example, pentoxy, 1-methylbutoxy, 2-methylbutoxy, 3-methylbutoxy, 1,1-dimethylpropoxy, 1,2-dimethylpropoxy, 2,2-dimethylpropoxy, 1-ethylpropoxy, hexoxy, 1-methylpentoxy, 2-methylpentoxy, 3-methylpentoxy, 4-methylpentoxy, 1,1-dimethylbutoxy, 1,2-dimethylbutoxy, 1,3-dimethylbutoxy, 2,2-dimethylbutoxy, 2,3-dimethylbutoxy, 3,3-dimethylbutoxy, 1-ethylbutoxy, 2-ethylbutoxy, 1,1,2-trimethylpropoxy, 1,2,2-trimethylpropoxy, 1-ethyl-1-methylpropoxy or 1-ethyl-2-methylpropoxy. C1-C8-Alkoxy is additionally, for example, heptyloxy, octyloxy, 2-ethylhexyloxy and positional isomers thereof.
- The term “fluorinated C1-C2-alkoxy” is a fluorinated C1-C2-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via an oxygen atom. The term “fluorinated C1-C3-alkoxy” is a fluorinated C1-C3-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via an oxygen atom. The term “fluorinated C1-C6-haloalkoxy” is a fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via an oxygen atom. Fluorinated C1-C2-alkoxy is, for example, OCH2F, OCHF2, OCF3, 1-fluoroethoxy, (R)-1-fluoroethoxy, (S)-1-fluoroethoxy, 2-fluoroethoxy, 1,1-difluoroethoxy, 1,2-difluoroethoxy, 2,2-difluoroethoxy, 1,1,2-trifluoroethoxy, 1,2,2-trifluoroethoxy, 2,2,2-trifluoroethoxy, 1,1,2,2-tetrafluoroethoxy or OC2F5. Fluorinated C1-C3-alkoxy, is additionally, for example, 1-fluoropropoxy, (R)-1-fluoropropoxy, (S)-1-fluoropropoxy, 2-fluoropropoxy, (R)-2-fluoropropoxy, (S)-2-fluoropropoxy, 3-fluoropropoxy, 1,1-difluoropropoxy, 2,2-difluoropropoxy, 2,3-difluoropropoxy, 3,3-difluoropropoxy, 3,3,3-trifluoropropoxy, (R)-2-fluoro-1-methylethoxy, (S)-2-fluoro-1-methylethoxy, (R)-2,2-difluoro-1-methylethoxy, (S)-2,2-difluoro-1-methylethoxy, (R)-1,2-difluoro-1-methylethoxy, (S)-1,2-difluoro-1-methylethoxy, (R)-2,2,2-trifluoro-1-methylethoxy, (S)-2,2,2-trifluoro-1-methylethoxy, 2-fluoro-1-(fluoromethyl)ethoxy, 1-(difluoromethyl)-2,2-difluoroethoxy, OCH2—C2F5, OCF2—C2F5 or 1-(CH2F)-2-fluoroethoxy. Fluorinated C1-C4-alkoxy is additionally, for example, 1-fluorobutoxy, (R)-1-fluorobutoxy, (S)-1-fluorobutoxy, 2-fluorobutoxy, 3-fluorobutoxy, 4-fluorobutoxy, 1,1-difluorobutoxy, 2,2-difluorobutoxy, 3,3-difluorobutoxy, 4,4-difluorobutoxy, 4,4,4-trifluorobutoxy or nonafluorobutoxy. Fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy is additionally, for example, 5-fluoropentoxy, undecafluoropentoxy, 6-fluorohexoxy or tridecafluorohexoxy.
- The term “C1-C4-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl” as used herein, refers to a straight-chain or branched alkyl group having 1 to 4 carbon atoms, as defined above, where one hydrogen atom is replaced by a C1-C4-alkoxy group, as defined above. The term “C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl” as used herein, refers to a straight-chain or branched alkyl group having 1 to 4 carbon atoms, as defined above, where one hydrogen atom is replaced by a C1-C6-alkoxy group, as defined above. Examples are methoxymethyl, ethoxymethyl, propoxymethyl, isopropoxymethyl, n-butoxymethyl, sec-butoxymethyl, isobutoxymethyl, tert-butoxymethyl, 1-methoxyethyl, 1-ethoxyethyl, 1-propoxyethyl, 1-isopropoxyethyl, 1-n-butoxyethyl, 1-sec-butoxyethyl, 1-isobutoxyethyl, 1-tert-butoxyethyl, 2-methoxyethyl, 2-ethoxyethyl, 2-propoxyethyl, 2-isopropoxyethyl, 2-n-butoxyethyl, 2-sec-butoxyethyl, 2-isobutoxyethyl, 2-tert-butoxyethyl, 1-methoxypropyl, 1-ethoxypropyl, 1-propoxypropyl, 1-isopropoxypropyl, 1-n-butoxypropyl, 1-sec-butoxypropyl, 1-isobutoxypropyl, 1-tert-butoxypropyl, 2-methoxypropyl, 2-ethoxypropyl, 2-propoxypropyl, 2-isopropoxypropyl, 2-n-butoxypropyl, 2-sec-butoxypropyl, 2-isobutoxypropyl, 2-tert-butoxypropyl, 3-methoxypropyl, 3-ethoxypropyl, 3-propoxypropyl, 3-isopropoxypropyl, 3-n-butoxypropyl, 3-sec-butoxypropyl, 3-isobutoxypropyl, 3-tert-butoxypropyl and the like.
- The term “C1-C2-alkoxy-methyl” as used herein, refers to methyl where one hydrogen atom is replaced by a C1-C2-alkoxy group, as defined above. Examples are methoxymethyl and ethoxymethyl. The term “C1-C4-alkoxy-methyl” as used herein, refers to methyl where one hydrogen atom is replaced by a C1-C4-alkoxy group, as defined above. Examples are methoxymethyl, ethoxymethyl, propoxymethyl, isopropoxymethyl, n-butoxymethyl, sec-butoxymethyl, isobutoxymethyl and tert-butoxymethyl.
- The term “fluorinated C1-C4-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl” as used herein, refers to a straight-chain or branched alkyl group having 1 to 4 carbon atoms, as defined above, where one hydrogen atom is replaced by a C1-C4-alkoxy group, as defined above, and wherein at least one, e.g. 1, 2, 3, 4 or all of the remaining hydrogen atoms (either in the alkoxy moiety or in the alkyl moiety or in both) are replaced by fluorine atoms. The term “fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl” as used herein, refers to a straight-chain or branched alkyl group having 1 to 4 carbon atoms, as defined above, where one hydrogen atom is replaced by a C1-C6-alkoxy group, as defined above, and wherein at least one, e.g. 1, 2, 3, 4 or all of the remaining hydrogen atoms (either in the alkoxy moiety or in the alkyl moiety or in both) are replaced by fluorine atoms. Examples are difluoromethoxymethyl (CHF2OCH2), trifluoromethoxymethyl (CF3OCH2), 1-difluoromethoxyethyl (CHF2OCH(CH3)), 1-trifluoromethoxyethyl (CF3OCH(CH3)), 2-difluoromethoxyethyl (CHF2OCH2CH2), 2-trifluoromethoxyethyl (CF3OCH2CH2), methoxy-difluoromethyl (CH3OCF2), 2-methoxy-1,1-difluoroethyl (CH3OCH2CF2), 2-methoxy-2,2-difluoroethyl (CH3OCF2CH2), and the like.
- The term “hydroxy-C1-C4-alkyl” as used herein, refers to a straight-chain or branched alkyl group having 1 to 4 carbon atoms, as defined above, where one hydrogen atom is replaced by a hydroxyl group. The term “hydroxy-C1-C6-alkyl” as used herein, refers to a straight-chain or branched alkyl group having 1 to 6 carbon atoms, as defined above, where one hydrogen atom is replaced by a hydroxyl group. Examples for hydroxy-C1-C4-alkyl include hydroxymethyl, 1-hydroxyethyl, 2-hydroxyethyl, 1-hydroxypropyl, 2-hydroxypropyl, 3-hydroxypropyl, 1-hydroxyprop-2-yl, 2-hydroxyprop-2-yl, 1-hydroxybutyl, 2-hydroxybutyl, 3-hydroxybutyl, 4-hydroxybutyl, 1-hydroxybut-2-yl, 2-hydroxybut-2-yl, 3-hydroxybut-2-yl, 4-hydroxybut-2-yl, hydroxy-tert-butyl and the like. Examples for hydroxy-C1-C6-alkyl are, apart those mentioned for hydroxy-C1-C4-alkyl, 1-hydroxypentyl, 2-hydroxypentyl, 3-hydroxypentyl, 4-hydroxypentyl, 5-hydroxypentyl, 1-hydroxyhexyl, 2-hydroxyhexyl, 3-hydroxyhexyl, 4-hydroxyhexyl, 5-hydroxyhexyl, 6-hydroxyhexyl and the like.
- The term “hydroxy-C1-C4-alkoxy” as used herein, refers to a C1-C4-alkoxy group, as defined above, where one hydrogen atom is replaced by a hydroxyl group. The term “hydroxy-C1-C6-alkoxy” as used herein, refers to a C1-C6-alkoxy group, as defined above, where one hydrogen atom is replaced by a hydroxyl group. Examples for hydroxy-C1-C4-alkoxy include hydroxymethoxy, 1-hydroxyethoxy, 2-hydroxyethoxy, 1-hydroxypropoxy, 2-hydroxypropoxy, 3-hydroxypropoxy, 1-hydroxy-2-propoxy, 2-hydroxy-2-propoxy, 1-hydroxybutoxy, 2-hydroxybutoxy, 3-hydroxybutoxy, 4-hydroxybutoxy, 1-hydroxy-2-butoxy, 2-hydroxy-2-butoxy, 3-hydroxy-2-butoxy, 4-hydroxy-2-butoxy, hydroxy-tert-butoxy and the like. Examples for hydroxy-C1-C6-alkoxy include, apart those mentioned for hydroxy-C1-C4-alkoxy, 1-hydroxypentoxy, 2-hydroxypentoxy, 3-hydroxypentoxy, 4-hydroxypentoxy, 5-hydroxypentoxy, 1-hydroxyhexoxy, 2-hydroxyhexoxy, 3-hydroxyhexoxy, 4-hydroxyhexoxy, 5-hydroxyhexoxy, 6-hydroxyhexoxy and the like.
- The term “C1-C4-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkoxy” as used herein, refers to a C1-C4-alkoxy group, as defined above, where one hydrogen atom is replaced by a C1-C4-alkoxy group, as defined above. The term “C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkoxy” as used herein, refers to a C1-C4-alkoxy group, as defined above, where one hydrogen atom is replaced by a C1-C6-alkoxy group, as defined above. Examples are methoxymethoxy, ethoxymethoxy, propoxymethoxy, isopropoxymethoxy, butoxymethoxy, sec-butoxymethoxy, isobutoxymethoxy, tert-butoxymethoxy, 1-methoxyethoxy, 1-ethoxyethoxy, 1-propoxyethoxy, 1-isopropoxyethoxy, 1-butoxyethoxy, 1-sec-butoxyethoxy, 1-isobutoxyethoxy, 1-tert-butoxyethoxy, 2-methoxyethoxy, 2-ethoxyethoxy, 2-propoxyethoxy, 2-isopropoxyethoxy, 2-butoxyethoxy, 2-sec-butoxyethoxy, 2-isobutoxyethoxy, 2-tert-butoxyethoxy, 1-methoxypropoxy, 1-ethoxypropoxy, 1-propoxypropoxy, 1-isopropoxypropoxy, 1-butoxypropoxy, 1-sec-butoxypropoxy, 1-isobutoxypropoxy, 1-tert-butoxypropoxy, 2-methoxypropoxy, 2-ethoxypropoxy, 2-propoxypropoxy, 2-isopropoxypropoxy, 2-butoxypropoxy, 2-sec-butoxypropoxy, 2-isobutoxypropoxy, 2-tert-butoxypropoxy, 3-methoxypropoxy, 3-ethoxypropoxy, 3-propoxypropoxy, 3-isopropoxypropoxy, 3-butoxypropoxy, 3-sec-butoxypropoxy, 3-isobutoxypropoxy, 3-tert-butoxypropoxy and the like.
- The term “C1-C2-alkylthio” is a C1-C2-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfur atom. The term “C1-C3-alkylthio” refers to a C1-C3-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfur atom. The term “C1-C4-alkylthio” is a C1-C4-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfur atom. The term “C1-C6-alkylthio” refers to a C1-C6-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfur atom. The term “C1-C10-alkylthio” refers to a C1-C10-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfur atom. C1-C2-Alkylthio is methylthio or ethylthio. C1-C3-Alkylthio is additionally, for example, n-propylthio or 1-methylethylthio (isopropylthio). C1-C4-Alkylthio is additionally, for example, butylthio, 1-methylpropylthio (sec-butylthio), 2-methylpropylthio (isobutylthio) or 1,1-dimethylethylthio (tert-butylthio). C1-C6-Alkylthio is additionally, for example, pentylthio, 1-methylbutylthio, 2-methylbutylthio, 3-methylbutylthio, 1,1-dimethylpropylthio, 1,2-dimethylpropylthio, 2,2-dimethylpropylthio, 1-ethylpropylthio, hexylthio, 1-methylpentylthio, 2-methylpentylthio, 3-methylpentylthio, 4-methylpentylthio, 1,1-dimethylbutylthio, 1,2-dimethylbutylthio, 1,3-dimethylbutylthio, 2,2-dimethylbutylthio, 2,3-dimethylbutylthio, 3,3-dimethylbutylthio, 1-ethylbutylthio, 2-ethylbutylthio, 1,1,2-trimethylpropylthio, 1,2,2-trimethylpropylthio, 1-ethyl-1-methylpropylthio or 1-ethyl-2-methylpropylthio.
- The term “fluorinated C1-C2-alkylthio” refers to a fluorinated C1-C2-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfur atom. The term “fluorinated C1-C3-alkylthio” refers to a fluorinated C1-C3-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfur atom. The term “fluorinated C1-C4-alkylthio” refers to a fluorinated C1-C4-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfur atom. The term “fluorinated C1-C6-alkylthio” refers to a fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfur atom. Fluorinated C1-C2-alkylthio refers to, for example, SCH2F, SCHF2, SCF3, 2-fluoroethylthio, 2,2-difluoroethylthio, 2,2,2-trifluoroethylthio, or SC2F5. Fluorinated C1-C3-alkylthio may additionally, for example, include 2-fluoropropylthio, 3-fluoropropylthio, 2,2-difluoropropylthio, 2,3-difluoropropylthio, 3,3,3-trifluoropropylthio, SCH2—C2F5, SCF2—C2F5 or 1-(CH2F)-2-fluoroethylthio. Fluorinated C1-C4-alkylthio may additionally, for example, include 4-fluorobutylthio or nonafluorobutylthio. Fluorinated C1-C6-alkylthio is additionally, for example, 5-fluoropentylthio, undecafluoropentylthio, 6-fluorohexylthio or dodecafluorohexylthio.
- The term “C1-C2-alkylsulfinyl” refers to a C1-C2-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfinyl [S(O)] group. The term “C1-C4-alkylsulfinyl” is a C1-C4-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfinyl [S(O)] group. The term “C1-C6-alkylsulfinyl” is a C1-C6-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfinyl [S(O)] group. C1-C2-Alkylsulfinyl is methylsulfinyl or ethylsulfinyl. C1-C4-Alkylsulfinyl is additionally, for example, n-propylsulfinyl, 1-methylethylsulfinyl (isopropylsulfinyl), butylsulfinyl, 1-methylpropylsulfinyl (sec-butylsulfinyl), 2-methylpropylsulfinyl (isobutylsulfinyl) or 1,1-dimethylethylsulfinyl (tert-butylsulfinyl). C1-C6-Alkylsulfinyl is additionally, for example, pentylsulfinyl, 1-methylbutylsulfinyl, 2-methylbutylsulfinyl, 3-methylbutylsulfinyl, 1,1-dimethylpropylsulfinyl, 1,2-dimethylpropylsulfinyl, 2,2-dimethylpropylsulfinyl, 1-ethylpropylsulfinyl, hexylsulfinyl, 1-methylpentylsulfinyl, 2-methylpentylsulfinyl, 3-methylpentylsulfinyl, 4-methylpentylsulfinyl, 1,1-dimethylbutylsulfinyl, 1,2-dimethylbutylsulfinyl, 1,3-dimethylbutylsulfinyl, 2,2-dimethylbutylsulfinyl, 2,3-dimethylbutylsulfinyl, 3,3-dimethylbutylsulfinyl, 1-ethylbutylsulfinyl, 2-ethylbutylsulfinyl, 1,1,2-trimethylpropylsulfinyl, 1,2,2-trimethylpropylsulfinyl, 1-ethyl-1-methylpropylsulfinyl or 1-ethyl-2-methylpropylsulfinyl.
- The term “fluorinated C1-C2-alkylsulfinyl” refers to a fluorinated C1-C2-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfinyl [S(O)] group. The term “fluorinated C1-C3-alkylsulfinyl” refers to a fluorinated C1-C3-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfinyl [S(O)] group. The term “fluorinated C1-C4-alkylsulfinyl” refers to a fluorinated C1-C4-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfinyl [S(O)] group. The term “fluorinated C1-C6-alkylsulfinyl” refers to a fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfinyl [S(O)] group. Fluorinated C1-C2-alkylsulfinyl is, for example, S(O)CH2F, S(O)CHF2, S(O)CF3, 2-fluoroethylsulfinyl, 2,2-difluoroethylsulfinyl, 2,2,2-trifluoroethylsulfinyl, or S(O)C2F5. Fluorinated C1-C3-alkylsulfinyl may additionally, for example, include 2-fluoropropylsulfinyl, 3-fluoropropylsulfinyl, 2,2-difluoropropylsulfinyl, 2,3-difluoropropylsulfinyl, 3,3,3-trifluoropropylsulfinyl, S(O)CH2—C2F5, S(O)CF2—C2F5 or 1-(CH2F)-2-fluoroethylsulfinyl. Fluorinated C1-C4-alkylsulfinyl may additionally, for example, include 4-fluorobutylsulfinyl or nonafluorobutylsulfinyl. Fluorinated C1-C6-alkylsulfinyl may additionally, for example, include 5-fluoropentylsulfinyl, undecafluoropentylsulfinyl, 6-fluorohexylsulfinyl or dodecafluorohexylsulfinyl.
- The term “C1-C2-alkylsulfonyl” refers to a C1-C2-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfonyl [S(O)2] group. The term “C1-C4-alkylsulfonyl” refers to a C1-C4-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfonyl [S(O)2] group. The term “C1-C6-alkylsulfonyl” is a C1-C6-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfonyl [S(O)2] group. C1-C2-Alkylsulfonyl refers to a methylsulfonyl or ethylsulfonyl. C1-C4-Alkylsulfonyl is additionally, for example, n-propylsulfonyl, 1-methylethylsulfonyl (isopropylsulfonyl), butylsulfonyl, 1-methylpropylsulfonyl (sec-butylsulfonyl), 2-methylpropylsulfonyl (isobutylsulfonyl) or 1,1-dimethylethylsulfonyl (tert-butylsulfonyl). C1-C6-Alkylsulfonyl is additionally, for example, pentylsulfonyl, 1-methylbutylsulfonyl, 2-methylbutylsulfonyl, 3-methylbutylsulfonyl, 1,1-dimethylpropylsulfonyl, 1,2-dimethylpropylsulfonyl, 2,2-dimethylpropylsulfonyl, 1-ethylpropylsulfonyl, hexylsulfonyl, 1-methylpentylsulfonyl, 2-methylpentylsulfonyl, 3-methylpentylsulfonyl, 4-methylpentylsulfonyl, 1,1-dimethylbutylsulfonyl, 1,2-dimethylbutylsulfonyl, 1,3-dimethylbutylsulfonyl, 2,2-dimethylbutylsulfonyl, 2,3-dimethylbutylsulfonyl, 3,3-dimethylbutylsulfonyl, 1-ethylbutylsulfonyl, 2-ethylbutylsulfonyl, 1,1,2-trimethylpropylsulfonyl, 1,2,2-trimethylpropylsulfonyl, 1-ethyl-1-methylpropylsulfonyl or 1-ethyl-2-methylpropylsulfonyl.
- The term “fluorinated C1-C2-alkylsulfonyl” refers to a fluorinated C1-C2-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfonyl [S(O)2] group. The term “fluorinated C1-C3-alkylsulfonyl” refers to a fluorinated C1-C3-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfonyl [S(O)2] group. The term “fluorinated C1-C4-alkylsulfonyl” refers to a fluorinated C1-C4-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfonyl [S(O)2] group. The term “fluorinated C1-C6-alkylsulfonyl” refers to a fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl group, as defined above, attached via a sulfonyl [S(O)2] group. Fluorinated C1-C2-alkylsulfonyl is, for example, S(O)2CH2F, S(O)2CHF2, S(O)2CF3, 2-fluoroethylsulfonyl, 2,2-difluoroethylsulfonyl, 2,2,2-trifluoroethylsulfonyl, S(O)2C2F5. Fluorinated C1-C3-alkylsulfonyl is additionally, for example, 2-fluoropropylsulfonyl, 3-fluoropropylsulfonyl, 2,2-difluoropropylsulfonyl, 2,3-difluoropropylsulfonyl, 3,3,3-trifluoropropylsulfonyl, S(O)2CH2—C2F5, S(O)2CF2—C2F5 or 1-(CH2F)-2-fluoroethylsulfonyl. Fluorinated C1-C4-alkylsulfonyl is additionally, for example, 4-fluorobutylsulfonyl or nonafluorobutylsulfonyl. Fluorinated C1-C6-alkylsulfonyl is additionally, for example, 5-fluoropentylsulfonyl, undecafluoropentylsulfonyl, 6-fluorohexylsulfonyl or dodecafluorohexylsulfonyl.
- C1-C4-Alkylcarbonyl refers to a straight-chain or branched alkyl group having from 1 to 4 carbon atoms), which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a carbonyl group (CO), such as in acetyl, propionyl, isopropylcarbonyl, butylcarbonyl, sec-butylcarbonyl, isobutylcarbonyl, and tert-butylcarbonyl. C1-C6-Alkylcarbonyl is a straight-chain or branched alkyl group having from 1 to 6 carbon atoms, which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a carbonyl group (CO). Examples include, apart those listed above for C1-C4-alkylcarbonylpentylcarbonyl, hexylcarbonyl and the constitutional isomers thereof.
- Fluorinated C1-C4-alkylcarbonyl refers to a straight-chain or branched fluorinated alkyl group having from 1 to 4 carbon atoms as defined above, which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a carbonyl group (CO). Fluorinated C1-C6-alkylcarbonyl is a straight-chain or branched fluorinated alkyl group having from 1 to 6 carbon atoms as defined above, which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a carbonyl group (CO). Examples include trifluoromethylcarbonyl, 2,2,2-trifluoroethylcarbonyl and the like.
- C3-C6-cycloalkylcarbonyl relates to a C3-C6-cycloalkyl group as defined above which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a carbonyl group (CO), such as in cyclopropylcarbonyl, cyclobutylcarbonyl, cyclopentylcarbonyl and cyclohexylcarbonyl.
- C1-C6-Alkoxycarbonyl refers to a straight-chain or branched alkoxy group having from 1 to 6, especially 1 to 4 carbon atoms (═C1-C4-alkoxycarbonyl), in particular 1 to 3 carbon atoms (═C1-C3-alkoxycarbonyl), which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a carbonyl group (CO), such as in methoxycarbonyl, ethoxycarbonyl, propyloxycarbonyl, and isopropyloxycarbonyl.
- Fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxycarbonyl refers to a straight-chain or branched fluorinated alkoxy group having from 1 to 6, especially 1 to 4 carbon atoms (=fluorinated C1-C4-alkoxycarbonyl), in particular 1 to 3 carbon atoms (=fluorinated C1-C3-alkoxycarbonyl) as defined above, which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a carbonyl group (CO). Examples include trifluoromethoxycarbonyl, 2,2,2-trifluoroethoxycarbonyl and the like.
- C1-C4-Alkylcarbonyloxy refers to a straight-chain or branched alkyl group having from 1 to 4 carbon atoms, which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a carbonyloxy group [C(O)—O—], such as in acet(yl)oxy, propionyloxy, isopropylcarbonyloxy, butylcarbonyloxy, sec-butylcarbonyloxy, isobutylcarbonyloxy, and tert-butylcarbonyloxy. C1-C6-Alkylcarbonyloxy is a straight-chain or branched alkyl group having from 1 to 6 carbon atoms, which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a carbonyloxy group [C(O—O—]. Examples include, apart those listed above for C1-C4-alkylcarbonyloxy, pentylcarbonyloxy, hexylcarbonyloxy and the constitutional isomers thereof.
- Fluorinated C1-C4-alkylcarbonyloxy refers to a straight-chain or branched fluorinated alkyl group having from 1 to 4 carbon atoms as defined above, which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a carbonyloxy group [C(O)—O—]. Fluorinated C1-C6-alkylcarbonyloxy is a straight-chain or branched fluorinated alkyl group having from 1 to 6 carbon atoms as defined above, which is bound to the remainder of the molecule via a carbonyloxy group [C(O)—O—]. Examples include trifluoromethylcarbonyloxy, 2,2,2-trifluoroethylcarbonyloxy and the like.
- Phenyl-C1-C2-alkyl is a phenyl group bound to the remainder of the molecule via a C1-C2-alkyl group. Examples are benzyl, 1-phenylethyl and 2-phenylethyl (phenethyl).
- The term “3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated heterocyclic ring containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom groups independently selected from N, O, S, NO, SO and SO2 and optionally also 1 or 2 C═O and/or C═S groups as ring members” denotes a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered, preferably a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6- or 7-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximum unsaturated heteromonocyclic ring containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 (preferably 1, 2 or 3) heteroatoms or heteroatom groups selected from N, O, S, SO and SO2 and optionally also 1 or 2 C═O and/or C═S groups as ring members.
- Unsaturated rings contain at least one C—C and/or C—N and/or N—N double bond(s). Maximally unsaturated rings contain as many conjugated C—C and/or C—N and/or N—N double bonds as allowed by the ring size. Maximally unsaturated 5- or 6-membered heterocyclic rings are aromatic. 7- and 8-membered rings cannot be aromatic. They are homoaromatic (7-membered ring, 3 double bonds) or have 4 double bonds (8-membered ring). Partially unsaturated rings contain less than the maximum number of C—C and/or C—N and/or N—N double bond(s) allowed by the ring size. The heterocyclic ring may be attached to the remainder of the molecule via a carbon ring member or via a nitrogen ring member. As a matter of course, the heterocyclic ring contains at least one carbon ring atom. If the ring contains more than one O ring atom, these are not adjacent.
- In heterocyclic rings containing N as a ring member this nitrogen atom may either be present as tertiary N formally bound by a double and a single bond (like in pyridyl) or may be present as secondary NH (if N is not part of a ring double bond). In case that N is actually present as NH, and the ring is substituted, the substituent may either be bound to a carbon ring atom or to such a secondary nitrogen ring atom. In case that N is actually present as NH, the ring may either be bound to the remainder of the molecule via a carbon ring atom or such a secondary nitrogen ring atom.
- Examples of a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6- or 7-membered saturated heterocyclic ring include: Oxiranyl, thiiranyl, aziridinyl, oxetanyl, thietanyl, azetidinyl, tetrahydrofuran-2-yl, tetrahydrofuran-3-yl, tetrahydrofuran-2-on-3-yl, tetrahydrofuran-2-on-4-yl, tetrahydrofuran-2-on-5-yl, tetrahydrofuran-2-thion-3-yl, tetrahydrofuran-2-thion-4-yl, tetrahydrofuran-2-thion-5-yl, tetrahydrothien-2-yl, tetrahydrothien-3-yl, tetrahydrothien-2-on-3-yl, tetrahydrothien-2-on-4-yl, tetrahydrothien-2-on-5-yl, tetrahydrothien-2-thion-3-yl, tetrahydrothien-2-thion-4-yl, tetrahydrothien-2-thion-5-yl, pyrrolidin-1-yl, pyrrolidine-2-on-1-yl, pyrrolidine-2,5-dion-1-yl, pyrrolidine-2-thion-1-yl, pyrrolidin-2-yl, pyrrolidin-3-yl, pyrrolidine-2-on-3-yl, pyrrolidine-2-on-4-yl, pyrrolidine-2-on-5-yl, pyrrolidine-2,5-dion-3-yl, pyrrolidine-2-thion-3-yl, pyrrolidine-2-thion-4-yl, pyrrolidine-2-thion-5-yl, pyrazolidin-1-yl, pyrazolidin-3-yl, pyrazolidin-4-yl, pyrazolidin-5-yl, imidazolidin-1-yl, imidazolidin-2-on-1-yl, imidazolidin-2-thion-1-yl, imidazolidin-2-yl, imidazolidin-4-yl, imidazolidin-2-on-4-yl, imidazolidin-2-thion-4-yl, oxazolidin-2-yl, oxazolidin-3-yl, oxazolidin-4-yl, oxazolidin-5-yl, isoxazolidin-2-yl, isoxazolidin-3-yl, isoxazolidin-4-yl, isoxazolidin-5-yl, thiazolidin-2-yl, thiazolidin-3-yl, thiazolidin-4-yl, thiazolidin-5-yl, isothiazolidin-2-yl, isothiazolidin-3-yl, isothiazolidin-4-yl, isothiazolidin-5-yl, 1,2,4-oxadiazolidin-3-yl, 1,2,4-oxadiazolidin-5-yl, 1,2,4-thiadiazolidin-3-yl, 1,2,4-thiadiazolidin-5-yl, 1,2,4-triazolidin-3-yl, 1,3,4-oxadiazolidin-2-yl, 1,3,4-thiadiazolidin-2-yl, 1,3,4-triazolidin-1-yl, 1,3,4-triazolidin-2-yl, 2-tetrahydropyranyl, 4-tetrahydropyranyl, 1,3-dioxan-5-yl, 1,4-dioxan-2-yl, piperidin-1-yl, piperidin-2-on-1-yl, piperidin-2,5-dion-1-yl, piperidine-2-thion-1-yl, piperidin-2-yl, piperidin-3-yl, piperidin-2-on-3-yl, piperidin-2,5-dion-3-yl, piperidin-2-thion-3-yl, piperidin-4-yl, hexahydropyridazin-3-yl, hexahydropyridazin-4-yl, hexahydropyrimidin-2-yl, hexahydropyrimidin-4-yl, hexahydropyrimidin-5-yl, piperazin-1-yl, piperazin-2-yl, 1,3,5-hexahydrotriazin-1-yl, 1,3,5-hexahydrotriazin-2-yl and 1,2,4-hexahydrotriazin-3-yl, morpholin-2-yl, morpholin-3-yl, morpholin-4-yl, thiomorpholin-2-yl, thiomorpholin-3-yl, thiomorpholin-4-yl, 1-oxothiomorpholin-2-yl, 1-oxothiomorpholin-3-yl, 1-oxothiomorpholin-4-yl, 1,1-dioxothiomorpholin-2-yl, 1,1-dioxothiomorpholin-3-yl, 1,1-dioxothiomorpholin-4-yl, azepan-1-, -2-, -3- or -4-yl, oxepan-2-, -3-, -4- or -5-yl, hexahydro-1,3-diazepinyl, hexahydro-1,4-diazepinyl, hexahydro-1,3-oxazepinyl, hexahydro-1,4-oxazepinyl, hexahydro-1,3-dioxepinyl, hexahydro-1,4-dioxepinyl and the like.
- Examples of a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated heterocyclic ring further include oxocane, thiocane, azocane, [1,3]diazocane, [1,4]diazocane, [1,5]diazocane, [1,5]oxazocane and the like.
- Examples of a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6- or 7-membered partially unsaturated heterocyclic ring include: 2,3-dihydrofur-2-yl, 2,3-dihydrofur-3-yl, 2,4-dihydrofur-2-yl, 2,4-dihydrofur-3-yl, 2,3-dihydrothien-2-yl, 2,3-dihydrothien-3-yl, 2,4-dihydrothien-2-yl, 2,4-dihydrothien-3-yl, 2-pyrrolin-2-yl, 2-pyrrolin-3-yl, 3-pyrrolin-2-yl, 3-pyrrolin-3-yl, 2-isoxazolin-3-yl, 3-isoxazolin-3-yl, 4-isoxazolin-3-yl, 2-isoxazolin-4-yl, 3-isoxazolin-4-yl, 4-isoxazolin-4-yl, 2-isoxazolin-5-yl, 3-isoxazolin-5-yl, 4-isoxazolin-5-yl, 2-isothiazolin-3-yl, 3-isothiazolin-3-yl, 4-isothiazolin-3-yl, 2-isothiazolin-4-yl, 3-isothiazolin-4-yl, 4-isothiazolin-4-yl, 2-isothiazolin-5-yl, 3-isothiazolin-5-yl, 4-isothiazolin-5-yl, 2,3-dihydropyrazol-1-yl, 2,3-dihydropyrazol-2-yl, 2,3-dihydropyrazol-3-yl, 2,3-dihydropyrazol-4-yl, 2,3-dihydropyrazol-5-yl, 3,4-dihydropyrazol-1-yl, 3,4-dihydropyrazol-3-yl, 3,4-dihydropyrazol-4-yl, 3,4-dihydropyrazol-5-yl, 4,5-dihydropyrazol-1-yl, 4,5-dihydropyrazol-3-yl, 4,5-dihydropyrazol-4-yl, 4,5-dihydropyrazol-5-yl, 2,3-dihydrooxazol-2-yl, 2,3-dihydrooxazol-3-yl, 2,3-dihydrooxazol-4-yl, 2,3-dihydrooxazol-5-yl, 3,4-dihydrooxazol-2-yl, 3,4-dihydrooxazol-3-yl, 3,4-dihydrooxazol-4-yl, 3,4-dihydrooxazol-5-yl, 3,4-dihydrooxazol-2-yl, 3,4-dihydrooxazol-3-yl, 3,4-dihydrooxazol-4-yl, 2-, 3-, 4-, 5- or 6-di- or tetrahydropyridinyl, 3-di- or tetrahydropyridazinyl, 4-di- or tetrahydropyridazinyl, 2-di- or tetrahydropyrimidinyl, 4-di- or tetrahydropyrimidinyl, 5-di- or tetrahydropyrimidinyl, di- or tetrahydropyrazinyl, 1,3,5-di- or tetrahydrotriazin-2-yl, 1,2,4-di- or tetrahydrotriazin-3-yl, 2,3,4,5-tetrahydro[1H]azepin-1-, -2-, -3-, -4-, -5-, -6- or -7-yl, 3,4,5,6-tetrahydro[2H]azepin-2-, -3-, -4-, -5-, -6- or -7-yl, 2,3,4,7-tetrahydro[1H]azepin-1-, -2-, -3-, -4-, -5-, -6- or -7-yl, 2,3,6,7-tetrahydro[1H]azepin-1-, -2-, -3-, -4-, -5-, -6- or -7-yl, tetrahydrooxepinyl, such as 2,3,4,5-tetrahydro[1H]oxepin-2-, -3-, -4-, -5-, -6- or -7-yl, 2,3,4,7-tetrahydro[1H]oxepin-2-, -3-, -4-, -5-, -6- or -7-yl, 2,3,6,7-tetrahydro[1H]oxepin-2-, -3-, -4-, -5-, -6- or -7-yl, tetrahydro-1,3-diazepinyl, tetrahydro-1,4-diazepinyl, tetrahydro-1,3-oxazepinyl, tetrahydro-1,4-oxazepinyl, tetrahydro-1,3-dioxepinyl and tetrahydro-1,4-dioxepinyl.
- Examples of a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered partially unsaturated heterocyclic ring further include 1,2,3,4,5,6-hexahydroazocine, 2,3,4,5,6,7-hexahydroazocine, 1,2,3,4,5,8-hexahydroazocine, 1,2,3,4,7,8-hexahydroazocine, 1,2,3,4,5,6-hexahydro-[1,5]diazocine,1,2,3,4,7,8-hexahydro-[1,5]diazocine and the like.
- Examples of a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6- or 7-membered maximally unsaturated (including aromatic) heterocyclic ring include 5- or 6-membered heteroaromatic rings, such as 2-furyl, 3-furyl, 2-thienyl, 3-thienyl, 1-pyrrolyl, 2-pyrrolyl, 3-pyrrolyl, 1-pyrazolyl, 3-pyrazolyl, 4-pyrazolyl, 5-pyrazolyl, 2-oxazolyl, 4-oxazolyl, 5-oxazolyl, 2-thiazolyl, 4-thiazolyl, 5-thiazolyl, 1-imidazolyl, 2-imidazolyl, 4-imidazolyl, 1,3,4-triazol-1-yl, 1,3,4-triazol-2-yl, 2-pyridinyl, 3-pyridinyl, 4-pyridinyl, 1-oxopyridin-2-yl, 1-oxopyridin-3-yl, 1-oxopyridin-4-yl, 3-pyridazinyl, 4-pyridazinyl, 2-pyrimidinyl, 4-pyrimidinyl, 5-pyrimidinyl and 2-pyrazinyl, and also homoaromatic radicals, such as 1H-azepine, 1H-[1,3]-diazepine and 1H-[1,4]-diazepine.
- Examples of a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered maximally unsaturated heterocyclic ring further include [1,3]diazocine, [1,5]diazocine and [1,5]diazocine.
- A 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated ring containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom groups independently selected from N, O, S, NO, SO, SO2, C═O and C═S as ring members is either saturated, partially unsaturated and carbocyclic (if it contains only C═O and/or C═S as heteroatom group and no further heteroatoms or heteroatom groups) or saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated heterocyclic. Examples are, in addition to the heterocyclic rings mentioned above, carbocyclic rings, such as cyclopropanonyl, cyclobutanonyl, cyclopentanonyl, cyclohexanonyl, cyclohexandionyl, cycloheptanonyl, cyclooctanonyl, cyclopropanthionyl, cyclobutanthionyl, cyclopentanthionyl, cyclohexanthionyl, cyclohexandithionyl, cycloheptanthionyl, cyclooctanthionyl, cyclopropenonyl, cyclopentenonyl, cyclohexenonyl and the like.
- The remarks made above and in the following with respect to preferred aspects of the invention, e.g. to preferred meanings of the variables R1, R2, R3a, R3b, R4a, R4b, R5a, R5b, R6, R7, R8, R9, R10, R11a, R11b, a and b of compounds I, to preferred compounds I and to preferred embodiments of the method or the use according to the invention, apply in each case on their own or in particular to combinations thereof.
- In a preferred embodiment, R1 is selected from hydrogen and C1-C6-alkyl, in particular from hydrogen and methyl, and is specifically hydrogen.
- In a preferred embodiment, R2 is selected from cyano, nitro, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl and fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, more preferably from C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C1-C4-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl and fluorinated C1-C4-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, even more preferably from C1-C6-alkyl and fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, in particular from methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl and CF3, more particularly from methyl, ethyl and CF3, and is specifically methyl or CF3.
- In a preferred embodiment, R3a and R3b, independently of each other, are selected from hydrogen, cyano, nitro, C1-C6-alkyl and fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl. More preferably, R3a is selected from hydrogen, cyano, nitro, C1-C6-alkyl and fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, and R3b is hydrogen. Even more preferably, R3a is selected from hydrogen and methyl and R3b is hydrogen. In particular, both R3a and R3b are hydrogen.
- In a preferred embodiment, R4a and R4b, independently of each other, are selected from hydrogen, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C1-C4-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl and fluorinated C1-C4-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, or form together a group ═O, or form together a group —(CH2)m—, where m is 2, 3 or 4, in particular 2 or 3, especially 2, thus forming together a spiro-bound ring. More preferably, R4a is selected from hydrogen, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C1-C4-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl and fluorinated C1-C4-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl and R4b is hydrogen, or R4a and R4b are methyl, or R4a and R4b form together a group —(CH2)m—, where m is 2, 3 or 4, in particular 2 or 3, especially 2, thus forming together a spiro-bound ring. In a particular embodiment, they are hydrogen.
- In a preferred embodiment, R5a is selected from hydrogen, halogen, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl and C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl and R5b is hydrogen. In particular, R5a is hydrogen or methyl, specifically hydrogen, and R5b is hydrogen.
- Preferably, each R8 as a substituent on R6 is independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, C1-C6-alkoxy and fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy. In particular, R8 is halogen, especially fluorine.
- R6 is thus preferably C1-C4-haloalkyl, more preferably fluorinated C1-C4-alkyl, in particular fluorinated C1-C2-alkyl, such as CH2F, CHF2, CF3 and CH2CF3, and specifically fluorinated methyl; very specifically CHF2 or CF3.
- Alternatively, R6 is preferably selected from C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl and fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, and is in particular fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl. In another particular embodiment, R6 is C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, specifically C1-C4-alkoxy-methyl and very specifically C1-C2-alkoxy-methyl.
- In another embodiment, R6 is C1-C4-alkyl which carries a hydroxyl substituent.
- Among C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, C1-C4-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl and fluorinated C1-C4-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl radicals R2, R4a, R4b, R5a and R6 preference is given to CH2OCH3, CH2CH2OCH3, CH2OCH2CH3, CH2CH2OCH2CH3, CH2OCF3, CH2CH2OCF3, CH2OCHF2 and CH2CH2OCHF2.
- In a preferred embodiment, each R7 is independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, cyano, nitro, hydroxyl, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C2-C6-alkenyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkenyl, C2-C6-alkynyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkynyl, C3-C8-cycloalkyl, fluorinated C3-C8-cycloalkyl, C1-C6-alkoxy and fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy. More preferably, each R7 is independently selected from halogen, C1-C4-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C4-alkyl, C1-C4-alkoxy and fluorinated C1-C4-alkoxy, and is in particular fluorine.
- In a preferred embodiment, a is 0 or 1. If a is 1, R2 is preferably bound in β-position to the nitrogen ring atom carrying R1.
- In a preferred embodiment, b is 0 or 1 and specifically 0.
- If not specified otherwise in a specific context, R9, R10, R11a and R11b have following preferred meanings:
- Preferably each R9 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, hydroxyl, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C1-C6-hydroxyalkyl, C3-C6-cycloalkyl, fluorinated C3-C6-cycloalkyl, C1-C6-alkoxy, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy, and —NR11aR11b, where R11a and R11b have one of the above general or, in particular, one of the below preferred meanings. In particular, each R9 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C1-C4-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C2-alkyl, C1-C4-hydroxyalkyl, C1-C4-alkoxy, fluorinated C1-C2-alkoxy, and —NR11aR11b, where R11a and R11b have one of the above general or, in particular, one of the below preferred meanings.
- Preferably, each R10 is independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, cyano, C1-C4-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C4-alkyl, C1-C4-alkoxy and fluorinated C1-C4-alkoxy, more preferably from F, Cl, cyano, CH3, CF3, OCH3 and OCF3, and in particular from F, CH3, CF3, OCH3 and OCF3.
- Preferably, R11a and R11b, independently of each other and independently of each occurrence, are selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C1-C6-alkylcarbonyl and fluorinated C1-C6-alkylcarbonyl.
- In a particular embodiment, the compounds of the invention are compounds of formula I.1
- wherein R2, R6, R7 and b have one of the above general or, in particular, one of the above preferred meanings, and a is 0 or 1.
- In a more particular embodiment, the compounds of the invention are compounds of formula I.1.1
- wherein
-
- R7a is H, Cl, F or methyl, in particular H or F, specifically H;
- a is 0 or 1; and
- R2, R6, R7 and b have one of the above general or, in particular, one of the above preferred meanings.
- In compounds I.1.1 (b-1) is preferably 0.
- In compounds I.1 and I.1.1 R2 is specifically methyl.
- Examples of preferred compounds are compounds of the following formulae Ia.1 to Ia.36, where the variables have one of the general or preferred meanings given above. Examples of preferred compounds are the individual compounds compiled in the tables 1 to 9360 below. Moreover, the meanings mentioned below for the individual variables in the tables are per se, independently of the combination in which they are mentioned, a particularly preferred embodiment of the substituents in question.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is H, R4b is H, R6 is CH2F and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is H, R4b is H, R6 is CHF2 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is H, R4b is H, R6 is CF3 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is H, R4b is H, R6 is CH2CHF2 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is H, R4b is H, R6 is CH2CF3 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is H, R4b is H, R6 is CF2CH3 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is H, R4b is H, R6 is CF2CHF2 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is H, R4b is H, R6 is CF2CF3 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is H, R4b is H, R6 is CH2OH and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is H, R4b is H, R6 is CF2OH and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is H, R4b is H, R6 is CH2OCH3 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is H, R4b is H, R6 is CH2OCH2CH3 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is H, R4b is H, R6 is CH2CH2OCH3 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is H, R4b is H, R6 is CH2CH2OCH2CH3 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is H, R4b is H, R6 is CH2OCHF2 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is H, R4b is H, R6 is CH2OCF3 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is H, R4b is H, R6 is CH2CH2OCHF2 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is H, R4b is H, R6 is CH2CH2OCF3 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each ease to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is H, R4b is H, R6 is CH2CH2OCH2CHF2 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is H, R4b is H, R6 is CH2CH2OCH2CF3 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is methyl, R4b is H, R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 20 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is ethyl, R4b is H, R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 20 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is CH2OCH3, R4b is H, R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 20 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is CH2OCH2CH3, R4b is H, R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 20 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is CH2CH2OCH3, R4b is H, R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 20 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is CH2CH2OCH2CH3, R4b is H, R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 20 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is CH2OCHF2, R4b is H, R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 20 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is CH2OCF3, R4b is H, R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 20 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is CH2CH2OCHF2, R4b is H, R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 20 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is CH2CH2OCF3, R4b is H, R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 20 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a is methyl, R4b is methyl, R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 20 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.1 in which R4a and R4b form together —CH2—CH2—, R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 20 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.2 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.3 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.4 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.5 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.6 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.7 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.8 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.9 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.10 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.11 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.12 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.13 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.14 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.15 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.16 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.17 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.18 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.19 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.20 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.21 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.22 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.23 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.24 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.25 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.26 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.27 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.28 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.29 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.30 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.31 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.32 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.33 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.34 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.35 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
- Compounds of the formula Ia.36 in which the combination of R4a, R4b and R6 is as defined in tables 1 to 260 and the combination of R5a, R5b and R7a for a compound corresponds in each case to one row of Table A.
-
TABLE A No. R7a R5a R5b A-1 H H H A-2 F H H A-3 Cl H H A-4 CH3 H H A-5 CHF2 H H A-6 CF3 H H A-7 OCH3 H H A-8 OCHF2 H H A-9 OCF3 H H A-10 cyclopropyl H H A-11 H CH3 H A-12 F CH3 H A-13 Cl CH3 H A-14 CH3 CH3 H A-15 CHF2 CH3 H A-16 CF3 CH3 H A-17 OCH3 CH3 H A-18 OCHF2 CH3 H A-19 OCF3 CH3 H A-20 cyclopropyl CH3 H A-21 H CH2CH3 H A-22 F CH2CH3 H A-23 Cl CH2CH3 H A-24 CH3 CH2CH3 H A-25 CHF2 CH2CH3 H A-26 CF3 CH2CH3 H A-27 OCH3 CH2CH3 H A-28 OCHF2 CH2CH3 H A-29 OCF3 CH2CH3 H A-30 cyclopropyl CH2CH3 H A-31 H CH2OCH3 H A-32 F CH2OCH3 H A-33 Cl CH2OCH3 H A-34 CH3 CH2OCH3 H A-35 CHF2 CH2OCH3 H A-36 CF3 CH2OCH3 H A-37 OCH3 CH2OCH3 H A-38 OCHF2 CH2OCH3 H A-39 OCF3 CH2OCH3 H A-40 cyclopropyl CH2OCH3 H A-41 H CH2OCH2CH3 H A-42 F CH2OCH2CH3 H A-43 Cl CH2OCH2CH3 H A-44 CH3 CH2OCH2CH3 H A-45 CHF2 CH2OCH2CH3 H A-46 CF3 CH2OCH2CH3 H A-47 OCH3 CH2OCH2CH3 H A-48 OCHF2 CH2OCH2CH3 H A-49 OCF3 CH2OCH2CH3 H A-50 cyclopropyl CH2OCH2CH3 H A-51 H CH2CH2OCH3 H A-52 F CH2CH2OCH3 H A-53 Cl CH2CH2OCH3 H A-54 CH3 CH2CH2OCH3 H A-55 CHF2 CH2CH2OCH3 H A-56 CF3 CH2CH2OCH3 H A-57 OCH3 CH2CH2OCH3 H A-58 OCHF2 CH2CH2OCH3 H A-59 OCF3 CH2CH2OCH3 H A-60 cyclopropyl CH2CH2OCH3 H A-61 H CH2CH2OCH2CH3 H A-62 F CH2CH2OCH2CH3 H A-63 Cl CH2CH2OCH2CH3 H A-64 CH3 CH2CH2OCH2CH3 H A-65 CHF2 CH2CH2OCH2CH3 H A-66 CF3 CH2CH2OCH2CH3 H A-67 OCH3 CH2CH2OCH2CH3 H A-68 OCHF2 CH2CH2OCH2CH3 H A-69 OCF3 CH2CH2OCH2CH3 H A-70 cyclopropyl CH2CH2OCH2CH3 H A-71 H CH3 CH3 A-72 F CH3 CH3 A-73 Cl CH3 CH3 A-74 CH3 CH3 CH3 A-75 CHF2 CH3 CH3 A-76 CF3 CH3 CH3 A-77 OCH3 CH3 CH3 A-78 OCHF2 CH3 CH3 A-79 OCF3 CH3 CH3 A-80 cyclopropyl CH3 CH3 A-81 H CH2CH3 CH3 A-82 F CH2CH3 CH3 A-83 Cl CH2CH3 CH3 A-84 CH3 CH2CH3 CH3 A-85 CHF2 CH2CH3 CH3 A-86 CF3 CH2CH3 CH3 A-87 OCH3 CH2CH3 CH3 A-88 OCHF2 CH2CH3 CH3 A-89 OCF3 CH2CH3 CH3 A-90 cyclopropyl CH2CH3 CH3 - Among the above compounds, preference is given to compounds Ia.1 and Ia.10.
- In a specific embodiment, the invention relates to compounds I selected from the compounds of the examples, either in form of free bases or of any pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof or a stereoisomer, the racemate or any mixture of stereoisomers thereof.
- The compounds of the present invention can be prepared by using routine techniques familiar to a skilled person. In particular, the compounds of the formula I can be prepared according to the following schemes, wherein the variables, if not stated otherwise, are as defined above.
- Compounds of formula I wherein R4b and R5b are H (=compounds I′) can be synthesized as described in scheme 1 below. The readily available quinoline 1 in which X is a leaving group, such as Cl, Br I or triflate, is reacted with a suitable boron compound of R6, such as R6-boronic acid (R6—B(OH)2) or the potassium (trifluoro)borate of R6 in a Suzuki coupling reaction to 2. The reaction is carried out in the presence of a Pd catalyst, such as Pd(OAc)2, in general in the presence of a phosphine ligand (e.g. tricyclohexylphosphine; di(adamantan-1-yl)(butyl)-phosphine etc.), or tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium(0) and the like. Quinoline 2 is then N-alkylated with a suitable protective group, such as benzyl, e.g. by reaction with benzyl bromide, to 3. Reduction of the quinolinium compound 3 with a suitable reduction agent, such as sodium borohydride and H2/Raney nickel, yields the 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinoline 4, which is then deprotected to 5. Reaction with the 2-halogenoacetamide 6, wherein Y is Cl, Br or I, affords the acetamide 7, the keto group of which is reduced with common reduction agents, like borane, borane-tetrahydrofurane-complex, borane-dimethylsulfide-complex or borohydrides such as sodium borohydride or LAH (lithium aluminium hydride) or DIBAL-H (diisobutyl aluminium hydride), to 8. Cyclization with formaldehyde/aldehyde/ketone 9 (C(O)R3aR3b=formaldehyde if R3a and R3b are hydrogen; another aldehyde if R3a is hydrogen and R3b is (fluorinated) alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, (fluorinated) alkenyl, (fluorinated) alkynyl, (fluorinated) cycloalkyl, phenyl, phenyl-alkyl or a heterocyclic ring; a ketone if R3a and R3b are (fluorinated) alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, (fluorinated) alkenyl, (fluorinated) alkynyl, (fluorinated) cycloalkyl, phenyl, phenyl-alkyl or a heterocyclic ring), generally in the presence of a strong acid, such as trifluoroacetic acid, yields I′.
- Alternatively, 2 can be reacted with the 2-halogenoacetamide 6 to 10, which is then reduced to 7.
- Compounds of formula I wherein R4a, R4b and R5b are H (=compounds II″) can alternatively be synthesized as described in scheme 2 below. The boronic acid 11 and the α,β-unsaturated ester 12 are reacted in a 1,4-addition in the presence of a Rhodium catalyst, e.g. [RhOH(COD)]2 or Rh(acac)(CO)2, if desired in the presence of a phosphine ligand, such as 1,4-bis(diphenylphosphino)butane (dppb), followed by lactam formation. The lactam 13 is then reduced with common reduction agents, like borane, borane-tetrahydrofurane-complex, borane-dimethylsulfide-complex or borohydrides such as sodium borohydride, to the tetrahydroquinoline 14. Like in the reaction sequence of scheme 1, reaction with the 2-halogenoacetamide 6, wherein Y is Cl, Br or I, affords the acetamide 15, the keto group of which is reduced with common reduction agents, like borane, borane-tetrahydrofurane-complex, borane-dimethylsulfide-complex or borohydrides such as sodium borohydride or LAH (lithium aluminium hydride) or DIBAL-H (diisobutyl aluminium hydride), to 16. Cyclization with formaldehyde/aldehyde/ketone 9, generally in the presence of a strong acid, such as trifluoroacetic acid, yields I″.
- For obtaining compounds I wherein R4a and R4b form together ═O, the lactam 13 is not reduced, but is directly reacted with the 2-halogenoacetamide 6 to 17, followed by reduction of the CO group in the amide to 18 and finally cyclization, as shown in scheme 3 below. Alternatively, compounds I′″ can be obtained as described below scheme 4.
- Compounds of formula I wherein R4a, R4b and R5b are H (=compounds I″) can alternatively be synthesized as described in scheme 4 below. The protected tetrahydrobenzodiazepine 19, wherein Z is a hydrogen or a halogen atom, such as Cl, Br or I and PG is a common protective group, such as a carbamate, especially boc, is acylated with the acrylic acid derivative 20, wherein LG is an appropriate leaving group, such as Cl or an anhydride or a chloroformate, in the presence of a base, such as triethylamine or Hünig's base, in an organic solvent, such as ether or methylene chloride. Reaction of 21 with a Lewis acid or a Brönstedt acid HA or irradiation with a suitable wavelength commonly derived from a mercury lamp in an adequate solvent, such as acetone or toluene, in a common photoreactor yields cyclization to 22. Reduction of the carbonyl group with common reduction agents like borohydrides such as sodium borohydride or borane-tetrahydrofurane-complex yields 23, which is deprotected using suitable reagents such as strong bases or acids to I″, wherein R4a and R4b and R5b are H. Compounds I″″ wherein R4a and R4b form together ═O can be obtained by skipping the reduction step to 23 and deprotecting 22.
- Alternatively, compound 22 can be directly synthesized by reacting the tetrahydrobenzodiazepine 19, wherein Z is —B(OH)2 with the acrylic acid derivative 20 in a 1,4-addition in the presence of a Rhodium catalyst, e.g. [RhOH(COD)]2 or Rh(acac)(CO)2, if desired in the presence of a phosphine ligand, such as 1,4-bis(diphenylphosphino)butane (dppb), followed by lactam formation to 22. This is then further reacted as described above.
- If compound 22 is deprotected, this yields compound I′″ as well as other compounds I in which (R2)a is not necessarily bound to the same position as in compounds I′″.
- If desired, substituents R1 different from hydrogen can be introduced for example via alkylation under typical conditions such as stirring in an appropriate solvent in the presence of an alkylhalide and a base or via other common substitution reactions, or via reductive amination using a suitable aldehyde or ketone in the presence of reduction agent, such as borohydrides, e.g. triacetoxyborohydride, sodium cyanoborohydride or sodium borohydride. —C(═O)R9 as radical R1 can be introduced via amidation under typical amidation conditions, e.g. via reaction with a compound X—C(═O)R9, where X is OH or a halogen atom, under heating and removal of reaction water or using a coupling reagent, such as DCC (dicyclohexylcarbodiimide), DIC (diisopropylcarbodiimide), HATU (O-(7-azabenzotriazol-1-yl)-N,N,N′,N′-tetramethyluronium hexafluorophosphate), HBTU ((O-benzotriazol-1-yl)-N,N,N′,N′-tetramethyluronium hexafluorophosphate), HCTU (1H-benzotriazolium-1-[bis(dimethylamino)methylene]-5-chloro tetrafluoroborate), BOP ((benzotriazol-1-yloxy)-tris(dimethylamino)phosphonium hexafluorophosphate), Py-BOP ((benzotriazol-1-yloxy)-tripyrrolidinphosphonium hexafluorophosphate) or Py-BrOP (bromotripyrrolidinphosphonium hexafluorophosphate).
- Compounds I wherein R5b is different from H can be prepared, for example, by reacting compound 22 with a compound LG-R5b in the presence of a base, wherein LG is an appropriate leaving group, such as Cl or Br.
- Alternatively to the method depicted in scheme 4, compounds I wherein R4a, R4b and R5b are H (=compounds I″) can be synthesized as described in scheme 5 below. Readily available anilines 24 are derivatized with carbonyl moieties 25 by acylation procedures employing appropriate leaving groups LG, such as chlorides or anhydrides, in the presence of a base such as triethylamine or Hünig's base, in an organic solvent, such as diethyl ether or methylene chloride to yield 26. Cyclization products 13 are received by irradiation with a suitable wavelength commonly derived from a mercury lamp in an adequate solvent such as acetone or toluene in a common photoreactor known to those skilled in the art. These are further reacted as depicted in schemes 2 and 3.
- Compounds I wherein R4a and R4b are not H or do not form together a group ═O can be prepared by standard derivatization methods of compounds wherein R4a and R4b form together a group ═O. For instance, compounds wherein R4a and R4b form together a group ═S may be prepared by reaction with a sulfurization agent, such as Lawesson's reagent or P2S5. Alkyl and related groups as radicals R4a and R4b may be introduced via Grignard reduction. Amino and related groups may be introduced via reductive amination. Hydroxyl group R4a or R4b may be introduced by reducing the carbonyl group. This may be alkylated to yield alkoxy and related groups R4a and R4b or substituted by diverse groups.
- If not otherwise indicated, the above-described reactions are generally carried out in a solvent at temperatures between room temperature and the boiling temperature of the solvent employed. Alternatively, the activation energy which is required for the reaction can be introduced into the reaction mixture using microwaves, something which has proved to be of value, in particular, in the case of the reactions catalyzed by transition metals (with regard to reactions using microwaves, see Tetrahedron 2001, 57, p. 9199 ff. p. 9225 ff. and also, in a general manner, “Microwaves in Organic Synthesis”, André Loupy (Ed.), Wiley-VCH 2002.
- The acid addition salts of compounds I are prepared in a customary manner by mixing the free base with a corresponding acid, where appropriate in solution in an organic solvent, for example a lower alcohol, such as methanol, ethanol or propanol, an ether, such as methyl tert-butyl ether or diisopropyl ether, a ketone, such as acetone or methyl ethyl ketone, or an ester, such as ethyl acetate.
- Routine experimentations, including appropriate manipulation of the reaction conditions, reagents and sequence of the synthetic route, protection of any chemical functionality that may not be compatible with the reaction conditions, and deprotection at a suitable point in the reaction sequence of the preparation methods are within routine techniques.
- Suitable protecting groups and the methods for protecting and deprotecting different substituents using such suitable protecting groups are well known to those skilled in the art; examples of which may be found in T. Greene and P. Wuts, Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis (3rd ed.), John Wiley & Sons, NY (1999), which is herein incorporated by reference in its entirety. Synthesis of the compounds of the invention may be accomplished by methods analogous to those described in the synthetic schemes described hereinabove and in specific examples.
- Starting materials, if not commercially available, may be prepared by procedures selected from standard organic chemical techniques, techniques that are analogous to the synthesis of known, structurally similar compounds, or techniques that are analogous to the above described schemes or the procedures described in the synthetic examples section.
- When an optically active form of a compound of the invention is required, it may be obtained by carrying out one of the procedures described herein using an optically active starting material (prepared, for example, by asymmetric induction of a suitable reaction step), or by resolution of a mixture of the stereoisomers of the compound or intermediates using a standard procedure (such as chromatographic separation, recrystallization or enzymatic resolution).
- Similarly, when a pure geometric isomer of a compound of the invention is required, it may be obtained by carrying out one of the above procedures using a pure geometric isomer as a starting material, or by resolution of a mixture of the geometric isomers of the compound or intermediates using a standard procedure such as chromatographic separation.
- The present invention further relates to a pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount of at least one compound as defined above or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, in combination with at least one pharmaceutically acceptable carrier and/or auxiliary substance.
- The present invention further relates to a compound I as defined above or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof for use as a medicament.
- The present invention also relates to a compound I as defined above or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof for the treatment of disorders which respond to the modulation of the 5-HT2C receptor.
- The present invention also relates to the use of a compound I as defined above or of an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof for the manufacture of a medicament for the treatment of disorders which respond to the modulation of the 5-HT2C receptor, and to a method for treating disorders which respond to the modulation of the 5-HT2C receptor, which method comprises administering to a subject in need thereof at least one compound I as defined above or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
- The compounds of the present invention are modulators of the 5-HT2C receptor. Specifically, the compounds of formula I are agonists or partial agonists of the 5-HT2C receptor. Thus, in a specific embodiment, the invention relates to a compound I as defined above or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof for the treatment of disorders which respond to 5-HT2C receptor agonists, further to the use of a compound I as defined above or of an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof for the manufacture of a medicament for the treatment of disorders which respond to 5-HT2C receptor agonists, and to a method for treating disorders which respond to 5-HT2C receptor agonists, which method comprises administering to a subject in need thereof at least one compound I as defined above or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
- Within the meaning of the invention, the term “disorder” denotes disturbances and/or anomalies which are as a rule regarded as being pathological conditions or functions and which can manifest themselves in the form of particular signs, symptoms and/or malfunctions. While the treatment according to the invention can be directed toward individual disorders, i.e. anomalies or pathological conditions, it is also possible for several anomalies, which may be causatively linked to each other, to be combined into patterns, i.e. syndromes, which can be treated in accordance with the invention.
- In one aspect of the invention, the diseases to be treated are disorders are damage of the central nervous system, disorders of the central nervous system, eating disorders, ocular hypertension, cardiovascular disorders, gastrointestinal disorders and diabetes.
- Disorders or diseases of the central nervous system are understood as meaning disorders which affect the spinal cord and, in particular, the brain. These are, for example, cognitive dysfunction, attention deficit disorder/hyperactivity syndrome and cognitive deficits related with schizophrenia, attention deficit/hyperactivity syndrome, personality disorders, affective disorders, motion or motor disorders, pain, migraine, sleep disorders (including disturbances of the Circadian rhythm), feeding disorders, diseases associated with neurodegeneration, addiction diseases, obesity or psoriasis.
- Examples of cognitive dysfunction are deficits in memory, cognition, and learning, Alzheimer's disease, age-related cognitive decline, and mild cognitive impairment, or any combinations thereof. Examples of personality disorders are schizophrenia and cognitive deficits related to schizophrenia. Examples of affective disorders are depression, anxiety, bipolar disorder and obsessive compulsive disorders, or any combination thereof. Examples of motion or motor disorders are Parkinson's disease and epilepsy. Examples of feeding disorders are obesity, bulimia, weight loss and anorexia, especially anorexia nervosa. Examples of diseases associated with neurodegeneration are stroke, spinal or head trauma, and head injuries, such as hydrocephalus.
- Pain condition includes nociceptive pain, neuropathic pain or a combination thereof. Such pain conditions or disorders can include, but are not limited to, post-operative pain, osteoarthritis pain, pain due to inflammation, rheumatoid arthritis pain, musculoskeletal pain, burn pain (including sunburn), ocular pain, the pain associated with dental conditions (such as dental caries and gingivitis), post-partum pain, bone fracture, herpes, HIV, traumatic nerve injury, stroke, post-ischemia, fibromyalgia, reflex sympathetic dystrophy, complex regional pain syndrome, spinal cord injury, sciatica, phantom limb pain, diabetic neuropathy, hyperalgesia and cancer.
- In certain other embodiments, the disease condition is bladder dysfunction, including urinary incontinence.
- Diabetes includes diabetes insipidus, diabetes mellitus, type I diabetes, type II diabetes, type III diabetes, diabetes secondary to pancreatic diseases, diabetes related to steroid use, diabetes complications, hyperglycemia and insulin resistance.
- The addiction diseases include psychiatric disorders and behavioral disturbances which are caused by the abuse of psychotropic substances, such as pharmaceuticals or narcotics, and also other addiction diseases, such as addiction to gaming (impulse control disorders not elsewhere classified). Examples of addictive substances are: opioids (e.g. morphine, heroin and codeine), cocaine; nicotine; alcohol; substances which interact with the GABA chloride channel complex, sedatives, hypnotics and tranquilizers, for example benzodiazepines; LSD; cannabinoids; psychomotor stimulants, such as 3,4-methylenedioxy-N-methylamphetamine (ecstasy); amphetamine and amphetamine-like substances such as methylphenidate, other stimulants including caffeine and nicotine. Addictive substances which come particularly into consideration are opioids, cocaine, amphetamine or amphetamine-like substances, nicotine and alcohol. Especially, addiction disorders include alcohol abuse, cocaine abuse, tobacco abuse and smoking cessation.
- With regard to the treatment of addiction diseases, particular preference is given to those compounds according to the invention of the formula (I) which themselves do not possess any psychotropic effect. This can also be observed in a test using rats, which, after having been administered compounds which can be used in accordance with the invention, reduce their self administration of psychotropic substances, for example cocaine.
- Examples of gastrointestinal disorders are irritable bowel syndrome.
- Preferably, the disorders are selected from the group consisting of bipolar disorder, depression, atypical depression, mood episodes, adjustment disorders, anxiety, panic disorders, post-traumatic syndrome, psychoses, schizophrenia, cognitive deficits of schizophrenia, memory loss, dementia of aging, Alzheimer's disease, neuropsychiatric symptoms in Alzheimer's disease (e.g. aggression), behavioral disorders associated with dementia, social phobia, mental disorders in childhood, attention deficit hyperactivity disorder, organic mental disorders, autism, mutism, disruptive behavior disorder, impulse control disorder, borderline personality disorder, obsessive compulsive disorder, migraine and other conditions associated with cephalic pain or other pain, raised intracranial pressure, seizure disorders, epilepsy, substance use disorders, alcohol abuse, cocaine abuse, tobacco abuse, smoking cessation, sexual dysfunction/erectile dysfunction in males, sexual dysfunction in females, premenstrual syndrome, late luteal phase syndrome, chronic fatigue syndrome, sleep disorders, sleep apnoea, chronic fatigue syndrome, psoriasis, Parkinson's disease, psychosis in Parkinson's disease, neuropsychiatric symptoms in Parkinson's disease (e.g. aggression), Lewy Body dementia, neuropsychiatric symptoms in Lewy Body dementia (e.g. aggression), spinal cord injury, trauma, stroke, pain, bladder dysfunction/urinary incontinence, encephalitis, meningitis, eating disorders, obesity, bulimia, weight loss, anorexia nervosa, ocular hypertension, cardiovascular disorders, gastrointestinal disorders, diabetes insipidus, diabetes mellitus, type I diabetes, type II diabetes, type III diabetes, diabetes secondary to pancreatic diseases, diabetes related to steroid use, diabetes complications, hyperglycemia and insulin resistance, and are specifically schizophrenia, depression, bipolar disorders, obesity, substance use disorders, neuropsychiatric symptoms in Alzheimer's disease (e.g. aggression) or neuropsychiatric symptoms in Parkinson's disease (e.g. aggression).
- The compounds of the invention may be used for a preventive treatment (prophylaxis), in particular as relapse prophylaxis or phase prophylaxis, but are preferably used for a treatment in its proper sense (i.e. non-prophylactic), i.e. for the treatment of acute or chronic signs, symptoms and/or malfunctions. The treatment can be orientated symptomatically, for example as the suppression of symptoms. It can be effected over a short period, be orientated over the medium term or can be a long-term treatment, for example within the context of a maintenance therapy.
- In another embodiment, the present invention relates to the use of a compound I as defined above or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof for preparing a medicament for preventing (the development of) a disease condition as described above and to a method for preventing (the development of) a disease condition as described above comprises administering to the subject in need of treatment thereof (e.g., a mammal, such as a human) a therapeutically effective amount of a compound I as defined above or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof. As used herein, the term “prevent” a disease condition by administration of any of the compounds described herein means that the detectable physical characteristics or symptoms of the disease or condition do not develop following the administration of the compound described herein. Alternatively, the method comprises administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound I as defined above or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, in combination with a therapeutically effective amount of at least one cognitive enhancing drug.
- In yet another embodiment, the present invention relates to the use a compound I as defined above or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof for preparing a medicament for preventing the progression (e.g., worsening) of a disease condition and to a method for preventing the progression (e.g., worsening) of a disease condition, which method comprises administering to the subject in need of treatment thereof (e.g., a mammal, such as a human) a therapeutically effective amount of a compound I as defined above or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
- There are several lines of evidence suggesting that 5-HT2C agonists or partial agonists would have therapeutic use in a variety of diseases, disorders and conditions.
- Knockout mice models lacking the 5-HT2C receptor exhibit hyperphagia, obesity and are more prone to seizures and sudden death [Tecott L H, Sun L M, Akana S F, Strack A M, Lowenstein D H, Dallman M F, Julius D (1995) Eating disorder and epilepsy in mice lacking 5-HT2C serotonin receptors. Nature 374:542-546]. They also exhibit compulsive-like behavior [Chou-Green J M, Holscher T D, Dallman M F, Akana S F (2003). Compulsive behavior in the 5-HT2C receptor knockout mouse. Phys. Behav. 78:641-649], hyperresponsiveness to repeated stress [Chou-Green J M, Holscher T D, Dallman M F, Akana S F (2003). Repeated stress in young and old 5-HT2C receptor knockout mouse. Phys. Behav. 79:217-226], wakefulness [Frank M G, Stryker M P, Tecott L H (2002). Sleep and sleep homeostasis in mice lacking the 5-HT2C receptor. Neuropsychopharmacology 27:869-873], hyperactivity and drug dependence [Rocha B A, Goulding E H, O'Dell L E, Mead A N, Coufal N G, Parsons L H, Tecott L H (2002). Enhanced locomotor, reinforcing and neurochemical effects of cocaine in serotonin 5-hydroxytryptamine 2C receptor mutant mice. J Neurosci. 22:10039-10045].
- 5-HT2C is unique among other G-protein-coupled receptors (GPCRs) in that its pre-mRNA is a substrate for base modification via hydrolytic deamination of adenosines to yield inosines. Five adenosines, located within a sequence encoding the putative second intracellular domain can be converted to inosines. This editing can alter the coding potential of the triplet codons and allows for the generation of multiple different receptor isoforms. The edited receptor isoforms were shown to have reduced ability to interact with G-proteins in the absence of agonist stimulation [Werry, T D, Loiacono R, Sexton P A, Christopoulos A (2008). RNA editing of the serotonin 5-HT2C receptor and its effects on cell signaling, pharmacology and brain function. Pharmac. Therap. 119:7-23].
- Edited 5-HT2C isoforms with reduced function are significantly expressed in the brains of depressed suicide victims [Schmauss C (2003) Serotonin 2C receptors: suicide, serotonin, and runaway RNA editing. Neuroscientist 9:237-242. Iwamoto K, Kato T (2003). RNA editing of serotonin 2C receptor in human postmortem brains of major mental disorders. Neurosci. Lett. 346:169-172] and in the learned helplessness rats (a well established animal model of depression) [Iwamotoa K, Nakatanib N, Bundoa M, Yoshikawab T, Katoa T (2005). Altered RNA editing of serotonin 2C receptor in a rat model of depression. Neurosci. Res. 53: 69-76] suggesting a link between 5-HT2C function and depression. There are also implications of edited 5-HT2C isoforms and spatial memory [Du Y, Stasko M, Costa A C, Davissone M T, Gardiner K J (2007). Editing of the serotonin 2C receptor pre-mRNA Effects of the Morris Water Maze, Gene 391:186-197]. In addition, fully edited isoforms of the human 5-HT2C receptor display a striking reduction in sensitivity to lysergic acid diethylamide (LSD) and to atypical antipsychotic drugs clozapine and loxapine, suggesting a possible role of the receptor in the etiology and pharmacology of schizophrenia [Niswender C M, Herrick-Davis K, Dilley G E, Meltzer H Y, Overholser J C, Stockmeier C A, Emeson R B, Sanders-Bush E (2001). RNA Editing of the Human Serotonin 5-HT2C Receptor: Alterations in Suicide and Implications for Serotonergic Pharmacotherapy. Neuropsychopharm. 24:478-491].
- Recently, the availability of potent and selective 5-HT2C receptor agonists made it possible to directly investigate the effects of 5-HT2C agonists and their therapeutic potential. Thus recent studies demonstrated that selective 5-HT2C agonists resulted in decreased food intake and body weight gain in normal and obese rats [Smith B M, et al. (2008). Discovery and structure-activity relationship of (1R)-8-chloro-2,3,4,5-tetrahydro-1-methyl-1H-3-benzazepine (Lorcaserin), a selective serotonin 5-HT2C receptor agonist for the treatment of obesity. J Med Chem 51:305-313. Thomsen W J, Grottick A J, Menzaghi F, Reyes-Saldana H, Espitia S, Yuskin D, Whelan K, Martin M, Morgan M, Chen W, Al-Shama H, Smith B, Chalmers D, Behan D (2008) Lorcaserin, A Novel Selective Human 5-HT2C Agonist: In Vitro and In Vivo Pharmacological Characterization. J Pharmacol Exp Ther. 325:577-587. Rosenzweig-Lipson S, Zhang J, Mazandarani H, Harrison B L, Sabb A, Sabalski J, Stack G, Welmaker G, Barrett J E, Dunlop J (2006) Antiobesity-like effects of the 5-HT2C receptor agonist WAY-161503. Brain Res. 1073-1074:240-251. Dunlop J, Sabb A L, Mazandarani H, Zhang J, Kalgaonker S, Shukhina E, Sukoff S, Vogel R L, Stack G, Schechter L, Harrison B L, Rosenzweig-Lipson S (2005). WAY-163909 [97bR, 10aR)-1,2,3,4,8,9,10,10a-octahydro-7bH-cyclopenta-[b][1,4]diazepino[6,7,1hi]indole], a novel 5-hydroxytryptamine 2C receptor-selective agonist with anorectic activity. J Pharmacol Exp Ther. 313:862-869.].
- Furthermore, selective 5-HT2C receptor agonists produce antidepressant effects in animal models of depression comparable to those of SSRIs but with a much faster onset of action and a therapeutic window that avoids antidepressant-induced sexual dysfunction. These agonists were also effective in animal models of compulsive behavior such as scheduled induced polydipsia and they also exhibited decreased hyperactivity and aggression in rodents [Rosenzweig-Lipson S, Sabb A, Stack G, Mitchell P, Lucki I, Malberg J E, Grauer S, Brennan J, Cryan J F, Sukoff Rizzo S J, Dunlop J, Barrett J E, Marquis K L (2007) Antidepressant-like effects of the novel, selective, 5-HT2C receptor agonist WAY-163909 in rodents. Psychopharmacology (Berlin) 192:159-170. Rosenzweig-Lipson S, Dunlop J, Marquis K L (2007) 5-HT2C receptor agonists as an innovative approach for psychiatric disorders. Drug news Perspect, 20: 565-571. Cryan, J F, Lucki I (2000). Antidepressant-like behavioral effects mediated by 5-Hydroxytryptamine 2C receptors. J. Pharm. Exp. Ther. 295:1120-1126.].
- Acute or chronic administration of 5-HT2C agonists decreases the firing rate of ventral tegmental area dopamine neurons but not that of substantia nigra. In addition 5-HT2C agonists reduce dopamine levels in the nucleus accumbens but not in the striatum (the region of the brain mostly associated with extrapyramidal side effects) [Di Matteo, V., Di Giovanni, G., Di Mascio, M., & Esposito, E. (1999). SB 242084, a selective serotonin 2C receptor antagonist, increases dopaminergic transmission in the mesolimbic system. Neuropharmacology 38, 1195-1205. Di Giovanni, G., Di Matteo, V., Di Mascio, M., & Esposito, E. (2000). Preferential modulation of mesolimbic vs. nigrostriatal dopaminergic function by serotonin 2C/2B receptor agonists: a combined in vivo electrophysiological and microdialysis study. Synapse 35, 53-61. Marquis K L, Sabb A L, Logue S F, Brennan J A, Piesla M J, Comery T A, Grauer S M, Ashby C R, Jr., Nguyen H Q, Dawson L A, Barrett J E, Stack G, Meltzer H Y, Harrison B L, Rosenzweig-Lipson S (2007) WAY-163909 [(7bR,10aR)-1,2,3,4,8,9,10,10a-octahydro-7bH-cyclopenta-[b][1,4]diazepino[6,7,1hi]indole]: A novel 5-hydroxytryptamine 2C receptor-selective agonist with preclinical antipsychotic-like activity. J Pharmacol Exp Ther 320:486-496.]. Therefore it is expected that 5-HT2C receptor agonists will selectively decrease mesolimibic dopamine levels without affecting the nigrostriatal pathway thus avoiding the EPS side effects of typical antipsychotics. Several 5-HT2C receptor agonists have shown antipsychotic activity in animal models of schizophrenia without EPS based on the lack of effect in catalepsy [Marquis K L, Sabb A L, Logue S F, Brennan J A, Piesla M J, Comery T A, Grauer S M, Ashby C R, Jr., Nguyen H Q, Dawson L A, Barrett J E, Stack G, Meltzer H Y, Harrison B L, Rosenzweig-Lipson S (2007) WAY-163909 [(7bR,10aR)-1,2,3,4,8,9,10,10a-octahydro-7bH-cyclopenta-[b][1,4]diazepino[6,7,1hi]indole]: A novel 5-hydroxytryptamine 2C receptor-selective agonist with preclinical antipsychotic-like activity. J Pharmacol Exp Ther 320:486-496. Siuciak J A, Chapin D S, McCarthy S A, Guanowsky V, Brown J, Chiang P, Marala R, Patterson T, Seymour P A, Swick A, Iredale P A (2007) CP-809,101, a selective 5-HT2C agonist, shows activity in animal models of antipsychotic activity. Neuropharmacology 52:279-290]. The antipsychotic activity of 5-HT2C receptor agonists without EPS coupled with their beneficial effects in mood disorders and cognition and their antiobesity like effects render 5-HT2C receptor agonists as unique agents to treat schizophrenia [Rosenzweig-Lipson S, Dunlop J, Marquis K L (2007) 5-HT2C receptor agonists as an innovative approach for psychiatric disorders. Drug news Perspect, 20: 565-571. Dunlop J, Marquis K L, Lim H K, Leung L, Kao J, Cheesman C, Rosenzweig-Lipson S (2006). Pharmacological profile of the 5-HT2C receptor agonist WAY-163909; therapeutic potential in multiple indications. CNS Dug Rev. 12:167-177.].
- In addition 5-HT2C modulation has been implicated in epilepsy [Isaac M (2005). Serotonergic 5-HT2C receptors as a potential therapeutic target for the antiepileptic drugs. Curr. Topics Med. Chem. 5:59:67], psoriasis [Thorslund K, Nordlind K (2007). Serotonergic drugs-a possible role in the treatment of psoriasis? Drug News Perspect 20:521-525], Parkinson's disease and related motor disorders [Esposito E, Di Matteo V, Pierucci M, Benigno A, Di Giavanni, G (2007). Role of central 5-HT2C receptor in the control of basal ganglia functions. The Basal Ganglia Pathophysiology: Recent Advances 97-127], behavioral deficits [Barr A M, Lahmann-Masten V, Paulus M, Gainetdinov R P, Caron M G, Geyer M A (2004). The selective serotonin-2A receptor antagonist M100907 reverses behavioral deficits in dopamine transporter knockout mice. Neuropsychopharmacology 29:221-228], anxiety [Dekeyne A, Mannoury la Cour C, Gobert A, Brocco M, Lejuene F, Serres F, Sharp T, Daszuta A, Soumier A, Papp M, Rivet J M, Flik G, Cremers T I, Muller O, Lavielle G, Millan M J (2208). S32006, a novel 5-HT2C receptor antagonists displaying broad-based antidepressant and anxiolytic properties in rodent models. Psychopharmacology 199:549-568. Nunes-de-Souza V, Nunes-de-Souza R L, Rodgers R J, Canto-de-Souza A (2008). 5-HT2 receptor activation in the midbrain periaqueductal grey (PAG) reduces anxiety-like behavior in mice. Behav. Brain Res. 187:72-79.], migraine [Leone M, Rigamonti A, D'Amico D, Grazzi L, Usai S. Bussone G (2001). The serotonergic system in migraine. Journal of Headache and Pain 2(Suppl. 1):S43-S46], Alzheimer's disease [Arjona A A, Pooler A M, Lee R K, Wurtman R J (2002). Effect of a 5-HT2C serotonin agonist, dexnorfenfluramine, on amyloid precursor protein metabolism in guinea pigs. Brain Res. 951:135-140], pain and spinal cord injury [Nakae A, Nakai K, Tanaka T, Hagihira S, Shibata M, Ueda K, Masimo T (2008). The role of RNA editing of the serotonin 2C receptor in a rat model of oro-facial neuropathic pain. The European Journal of Neuroscience 27:2373-2379. Nakae A, Nakai K, Tanaka T, Takashina M, Hagihira S, Shibata M, Ueda K, Mashimo T (2008). Serotonin 2C receptor mRNA editing in neuropathic pain model. Neurosci. Res. 60:228-231. Kao T, Shumsky J S, Jacob-Vadakot S, Timothy H B, Murray M, Moxon, K A (2006). Role of the 5-HT2C receptor in improving weight-supported stepping in adult rats spinalized as neonates. Brain Res. 1112:159-168.], sexual dysfunction [Motofei I G (2008). A dual physiological character for sexual function: the role of serotonergic receptors. BJU International 101:531-534. Shimada I, Maeno K, Kondoh Y, Kaku H, Sugasawa K, Kimura Y, Hatanaka K,; Naitou Y, Wanibuchi F, Sakamoto S,; Tsukamoto S (2008). Synthesis and structure-activity relationships of a series of benzazepine derivatives as 5-HT2C receptor agonists. Bioorg. Med. Chem. 16:3309-3320.], smoking cessation [Fletcher P J, Le A D, Higgins G A (2008). Serotonin receptors as potential targets for modulation of nicotine use and dependence. Progress Brain Res. 172:361-83], substance dependence [Bubar M J, Cunningham K A (2008). Prospects for serotonin 5-HT2R pharmacotherapy in psychostimulant abuse. Progress Brain Res. 172:319-46], and ocular hypertension [Sharif N A, McLaughlin M A, Kelly C R (2006). AL-34662: a potent, selective, and efficacious ocular hypotensive serotonin-2 receptor agonist. J Ocul Pharmacol Ther. 23:1-13].
- Further, 5HT modulation can be useful in the treatment of pain, both neuropathic and nociceptive pain, see for example U.S. Patent application publication US2007/0225277. Obata, Hideaki; Ito, Naomi; Sasaki, Masayuki; Saito, Shigeru; Goto, Fumio. Possible involvement of spinal noradrenergic mechanisms in the antiallodynic effect of intrathecally administered 5-HT2C receptor agonists in the rats with peripheral nerve injury. European Journal of Pharmacology (2007), 567(1-2), 89-94. Serotonin 2C receptor mRNA editing neuropathic pain model. Nakae, Aya; Nakai, Kunihiro; Tanaka, Tatsuya; Takashina, Masaki; Hagihira, Satoshi; Shibata, Masahiko; Ueda, Koichi; Mashimo, Takashi. Department of Anesthesiology & Intensive Care Medicine, Graduate School of Medicine, Osaka University, Neuroscience Research (Amsterdam, Netherlands) (2008), 60(2), 228-231. Antiallodynic effects of intrathecally administered 5-HT2C receptor agonists in rats with nerve injury. Obata, Hideaki; Saito, Shigeru; Sakurazawa, Shinobu; Sasaki, Masayuki; Usui, Tadashi; Goto, Fumio. Department of Anesthesiology, Gunma University Graduate School of Medicine, Maebashi, Gunma, Japan. Pain (2004), 108(1-2), 163-169. Influence of 5,7-dihydroxytryptamine (5,7-DHT) on the antinociceptive effect of serotonin (5-HT) 5-HT2C receptor agonist in male and female rats. Brus, Ryszard; Kasperska, Alicja; Oswiecimska, Joanna; Szkilnik, Ryszard. Department of Pharmacology, Silesian Medical University, Zabrze, Pol. Medical Science Monitor (1997), 3(5), 654-656.
- Modulation of 5HT2 receptors may be beneficial in the treatment of conditions related to bladder function, in particular, urinary incontinence. [Discovery of a novel azepine series of potent and selective 5-HT2C agonists as potential treatments for urinary incontinence. Brennan, Paul E.; Whitlock, Gavin A.; Ho, Danny K. H.; Conlon, Kelly; McMurray, Gordon. Bioorganic & Medicinal Chemistry Letters (2009), 19(17), 4999-5003. Investigation of the role of 5-HT2 receptor subtypes in the control of the bladder and the urethra in the anesthetized female rat. Mbaki, Y.; Ramage, A. G. Department of Pharmacology, University College London, London, UK. British Journal of Pharmacology (2008), 155(3), 343-356.] In particular, compounds with agonist activity at 5-HT2C have been shown to be useful in treating urinary incontinence, see for example U.S. Patent application publications US2008/0146583 and US 2007/0225274.
- Further pre-clinical data suggest that 5-HT2C agonists could be useful for the treatment of a number of psychiatric diseases, including schizophrenia, bipolar disorders, depression/anxiety, substance use disorders and especially disorders like neuropsychiatric symptoms in Alzheimer's disease: Aggression, psychosis/agitation represent key unmet medical needs. Clinical (Shen JHQ et al., A 6-week randomized, double-blind, placebo-controlled, comparator referenced trial of vabicaserin in acute schizophrenia. Journal of Psychiatric Research 53 (2014) 14-22; Liu J et al., Prediction of Efficacy of Vabicaserin, a 5-HT2C Agonist, for the Treatment of Schizophrenia Using a Quantitative Systems Pharmacology Model. CPT Pharmacometrics Syst. Pharmacol. (2014) 3, e111;) and preclinical data (Dunlop J et al., Characterization of Vabicaserin (SCA-136), a Selective 5-Hydroxytryptamine 2C Receptor Agonist, J Pharmacol Exp Ther (2011) 337, 673-80; Siuciak J et al., CP-809,101, a selective 5-HT2C agonist, shows activity in animal models of antipsychotic activity. Neuropharmacology 52 (2007) 279-290; Mosienko V et al., Exaggerated aggression and decreased anxiety in mice deficient in brain serotonin. Transl Psychiatry (2012) 2, e122; Del Guidice T et al., Stimulation of 5-HT2C Receptors Improves Cognitive Deficits Induced by Human Tryptophan Hydroxylase2 Loss of Function Mutation. Neuropsychopharmacology (2014) 39, 1125-1134; Rosenzweig-Lipson et al., Antidepressant-like effects of the novel, selective, 5-HT2C receptor agonist WAY-163909 in rodents. Psychopharmacology (2007) 192:159-170) suggest 5-HT2C receptor stimulation to result in therapeutic efficacy in aggression, psychosis agitation and moderate pro-cognitive effects (Del Guidice T et al., Stimulation of 5-HT2C Receptors Improves Cognitive Deficits Induced by Human Tryptophan Hydroxylase2 Loss of Function Mutation. Neuropsychopharmacology (2014) 39, 1125-1134; Siuciak J et al., CP-809,101, a selective 5-HT2C agonist, shows activity in animal models of antipsychotic activity. Neuropharmacology 52 (2007) 279-290).
- In the use and the method of the invention, an effective quantity of one or more compounds, as a rule formulated in accordance with pharmaceutical and veterinary practice, is administered to the individual to be treated, preferably a mammal, in particular a human being, productive animal or domestic animal. Whether such a treatment is indicated, and in which form it is to take place, depends on the individual case and is subject to medical assessment (diagnosis) which takes into consideration signs, symptoms and/or malfunctions which are present, the risks of developing particular signs, symptoms and/or malfunctions, and other factors.
- Actual dosage levels of active ingredients in the pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention can be varied so as to obtain an amount of the active compound(s) that is effective to achieve the desired therapeutic response for a particular subject (e.g., a mammal, preferably, a human (patient)), compositions and mode of administration. The selected dosage level will depend upon the activity of the particular compound, the route of administration, the severity of the condition being treated and the condition and prior medical history of the patient being treated. However, it is within the skill of the art to start doses of the compound at levels lower than required to achieve the desired therapeutic effect and to gradually increase the dosage until the desired effect is achieved.
- Compounds of the present invention can also be administered to a subject as a pharmaceutical composition comprising the compounds of interest in combination with at least one pharmaceutically acceptable carriers. The phrase “therapeutically effective amount” of the compound of the present invention means a sufficient amount of the compound to treat disorders, at a reasonable benefit/risk ratio applicable to any medical treatment. It will be understood, however, that the total daily usage of the compounds and compositions of the present invention will be decided by the attending physician within the scope of sound medical judgment. The specific therapeutically effective dose level for any particular patient will depend upon a variety of factors including the disorder being treated and the severity of the disorder; activity of the specific compound employed; the specific composition employed; the age, body weight, general health, sex and diet of the patient; the time of administration, route of administration, and rate of excretion of the specific compound employed; the duration of the treatment; drugs used in combination or coincidental with the specific compound employed; and like factors well-known in the medical arts. For example, it is well within the skill of the art to start doses of the compound at levels lower than required to achieve the desired therapeutic effect and to gradually increase the dosage until the desired effect is achieved.
- The total daily dose of the compounds of this invention administered to a subject (namely, a mammal, such as a human) ranges from about 0.01 mg/kg body weight to about 100 mg/kg body weight. More preferable doses can be in the range of from about 0.01 mg/kg body weight to about 30 mg/kg body weight. If desired, the effective daily dose can be divided into multiple doses for purposes of administration. Consequently, single dose compositions may contain such amounts or submultiples thereof to make up the daily dose.
- In one aspect, the present invention provides pharmaceutical compositions. The pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention comprise the compounds of the present invention or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt or solvate thereof. The pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention comprise compounds of the present invention that can be formulated together with at least one non-toxic pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
- In yet another embodiment, the present invention provides a pharmaceutical composition comprising compounds of the present invention or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, alone or in combination with one or more compounds that are not the compounds of the present invention. Examples of one or more compounds that can be combined with the compounds of the present invention in pharmaceutical compositions, include, but are not limited to, one or more cognitive enhancing drugs.
- The pharmaceutical compositions of this present invention can be administered to a subject (e.g., a mammal, such as a human) orally, rectally, parenterally, intracisternally, intravaginally, intraperitoneally, topically (as by powders, ointments or drops), bucally or as an oral or nasal spray. The term “parenterally” as used herein, refers to modes of administration which include intravenous, intramuscular, intraperitoneal, intrasternal, subcutaneous and intraarticular injection and infusion.
- The term “pharmaceutically acceptable carrier” as used herein, means a nontoxic, inert solid, semi-solid or liquid filler, diluent, encapsulating material or formulation auxiliary of any type. Some examples of materials which can serve as pharmaceutically acceptable carriers are sugars such as, but not limited to, lactose, glucose and sucrose; starches such as, but not limited to, corn starch and potato starch; cellulose and its derivatives such as, but not limited to, sodium carboxymethyl cellulose, ethyl cellulose and cellulose acetate; powdered tragacanth; malt; gelatin; talc; excipients such as, but not limited to, cocoa butter and suppository waxes; oils such as, but not limited to, peanut oil, cottonseed oil, safflower oil, sesame oil, olive oil, corn oil and soybean oil; glycols; such a propylene glycol; esters such as, but not limited to, ethyl oleate and ethyl laurate; agar; buffering agents such as, but not limited to, magnesium hydroxide and aluminum hydroxide; alginic acid; pyrogen-free water; isotonic saline; Ringer's solution; ethyl alcohol, and phosphate buffer solutions, as well as other non-toxic compatible lubricants such as, but not limited to, sodium lauryl sulfate and magnesium stearate, as well as coloring agents, releasing agents, coating agents, sweetening, flavoring and perfuming agents, preservatives and antioxidants can also be present in the composition, according to the judgment of the formulator.
- Pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention for parenteral injection comprise pharmaceutically acceptable sterile aqueous or nonaqueous solutions, dispersions, suspensions or emulsions as well as sterile powders for reconstitution into sterile injectable solutions or dispersions just prior to use. Examples of suitable aqueous and nonaqueous carriers, diluents, solvents or vehicles include water, ethanol, polyols (such as glycerol, propylene glycol, polyethylene glycol and the like), vegetable oils (such as olive oil), injectable organic esters (such as ethyl oleate) and suitable mixtures thereof. Proper fluidity can be maintained, for example, by the use of coating materials such as lecithin, by the maintenance of the required particle size in the case of dispersions and by the use of surfactants.
- These compositions may also contain adjuvants such as preservatives, wetting agents, emulsifying agents and dispersing agents. Prevention of the action of microorganisms can be ensured by the inclusion of various antibacterial and antifungal agents, for example, paraben, chlorobutanol, phenol sorbic acid and the like. It may also be desirable to include isotonic agents such as sugars, sodium chloride and the like. Prolonged absorption of the injectable pharmaceutical form can be brought about by the inclusion of agents which delay absorption such as aluminum monostearate and gelatin.
- In some cases, in order to prolong the effect of the drug, it is desirable to slow the absorption of the drug from subcutaneous or intramuscular injection. This can be accomplished by the use of a liquid suspension of crystalline or amorphous material with poor water solubility. The rate of absorption of the drug then depends upon its rate of dissolution which, in turn, may depend upon crystal size and crystalline form. Alternatively, delayed absorption of a parenterally administered drug form is accomplished by dissolving or suspending the drug in an oil vehicle.
- Injectable depot forms are made by forming microencapsule matrices of the drug in biodegradable polymers such as polylactide-polyglycolide. Depending upon the ratio of drug to polymer and the nature of the particular polymer employed, the rate of drug release can be controlled. Examples of other biodegradable polymers include poly(orthoesters) and poly(anhydrides). Depot injectable formulations are also prepared by entrapping the drug in liposomes or microemulsions which are compatible with body tissues.
- The injectable formulations can be sterilized, for example, by filtration through a bacterial-retaining filter or by incorporating sterilizing agents in the form of sterile solid compositions which can be dissolved or dispersed in sterile water or other sterile injectable medium just prior to use.
- Solid dosage forms for oral administration include capsules, tablets, pills, powders and granules. In such solid dosage forms, the active compound may be mixed with at least one inert, pharmaceutically acceptable excipient or carrier, such as sodium citrate or dicalcium phosphate and/or a) fillers or extenders such as starches, lactose, sucrose, glucose, mannitol and silicic acid; b) binders such as carboxymethylcellulose, alginates, gelatin, polyvinylpyrrolidone, sucrose and acacia; c) humectants such as glycerol; d) disintegrating agents such as agar-agar, calcium carbonate, potato or tapioca starch, alginic acid, certain silicates and sodium carbonate; e) solution retarding agents such as paraffin; f) absorption accelerators such as quaternary ammonium compounds; g) wetting agents such as cetyl alcohol and glycerol monostearate; h) absorbents such as kaolin and bentonite clay and i) lubricants such as talc, calcium stearate, magnesium stearate, solid polyethylene glycols, sodium lauryl sulfate and mixtures thereof. In the case of capsules, tablets and pills, the dosage form may also comprise buffering agents.
- Solid compositions of a similar type may also be employed as fillers in soft and hard-filled gelatin capsules using such carriers as lactose or milk sugar as well as high molecular weight polyethylene glycols and the like.
- The solid dosage forms of tablets, dragees, capsules, pills and granules can be prepared with coatings and shells such as enteric coatings and other coatings well-known in the pharmaceutical formulating art. They may optionally contain opacifying agents and may also be of a composition such that they release the active ingredient(s) only, or preferentially, in a certain part of the intestinal tract, optionally, in a delayed manner. Examples of embedding compositions which can be used include polymeric substances and waxes.
- The active compounds can also be in micro-encapsulated form, if appropriate, with one or more of the above-mentioned carriers.
- Liquid dosage forms for oral administration include pharmaceutically acceptable emulsions, solutions, suspensions, syrups and elixirs. In addition to the active compounds, the liquid dosage forms may contain inert diluents commonly used in the art such as, for example, water or other solvents, solubilizing agents and emulsifiers such as ethyl alcohol, isopropyl alcohol, ethyl carbonate, ethyl acetate, benzyl alcohol, benzyl benzoate, propylene glycol, 1,3-butylene glycol, dimethyl formamide, oils (in particular, cottonseed, groundnut, corn, germ, olive, castor and sesame oils), glycerol, tetrahydrofurfuryl alcohol, polyethylene glycols and fatty acid esters of sorbitan and mixtures thereof.
- Besides inert diluents, the oral compositions may also include adjuvants such as wetting agents, emulsifying and suspending agents, sweetening, flavoring and perfuming agents.
- Suspensions, in addition to the active compounds, may contain suspending agents as, for example, ethoxylated isostearyl alcohols, polyoxyethylene sorbitol and sorbitan esters, microcrystalline cellulose, aluminum metahydroxide, bentonite, agar-agar, tragacanth and mixtures thereof.
- Compositions for rectal or vaginal administration are preferably suppositories which can be prepared by mixing the compounds of this invention with suitable non-irritating carriers or carriers such as cocoa butter, polyethylene glycol or a suppository wax which are solid at room temperature but liquid at body temperature and therefore melt in the rectum or vaginal cavity and release the active compound.
- Compounds of the present invention can also be administered in the form of liposomes. As is known in the art, liposomes are generally derived from phospholipids or other lipid substances. Liposomes are formed by mono- or multi-lamellar hydrated liquid crystals which are dispersed in an aqueous medium. Any non-toxic, physiologically acceptable and metabolizable lipid capable of forming liposomes can be used. The present compositions in liposome form can contain, in addition to a compound of the present invention, stabilizers, preservatives, excipients and the like. The preferred lipids are natural and synthetic phospholipids and phosphatidyl cholines (lecithins) used separately or together.
- Methods to form liposomes are known in the art. See, for example, Prescott, Ed., Methods in Cell Biology, Volume XIV, Academic Press, New York, N.Y. (1976), p. 33 et seq.
- Dosage forms for topical administration of a compound of the present invention include powders, sprays, ointments and inhalants. The active compound may be mixed under sterile conditions with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier and any needed preservatives, buffers or propellants which may be required. Ophthalmic formulations, eye ointments, powders and solutions are also contemplated as being within the scope of this invention.
- The compounds of the present invention can be used in the form of pharmaceutically acceptable salts derived from inorganic or organic acids. The phrase “pharmaceutically acceptable salt” means those salts which are, within the scope of sound medical judgment, suitable for use in contact with the tissues of humans and lower animals without undue toxicity, irritation, allergic response and the like and are commensurate with a reasonable benefit/risk ratio.
- Pharmaceutically acceptable salts are well known in the art. For example, S. M. Berge et al. describe pharmaceutically acceptable salts in detail in (J. Pharmaceutical Sciences, 1977, 66: 1 et seq.). The salts can be prepared in situ during the final isolation and purification of the compounds of the invention or separately by reacting a free base function with a suitable organic acid. Representative acid addition salts include, but are not limited to acetate, adipate, alginate, citrate, aspartate, benzoate, benzenesulfonate, bisulfate, butyrate, camphorate, camphorsulfonate, digluconate, glycerophosphate, hemisulfate, heptanoate, hexanoate, fumarate, hydrochloride, hydrobromide, hydroiodide, 2-hydroxyethansulfonate (isothionate), lactate, malate, maleate, methanesulfonate, nicotinate, 2-naphthalenesulfonate, oxalate, palmitoate, pectinate, persulfate, 3-phenylpropionate, picrate, pivalate, propionate, succinate, tartrate, thiocyanate, phosphate, glutamate, bicarbonate, p-toluenesulfonate and undecanoate. Also, the basic nitrogen-containing groups can be quaternized with such agents as lower alkyl halides such as, but not limited to, methyl, ethyl, propyl, and butyl chlorides, bromides and iodides; dialkyl sulfates like dimethyl, diethyl, dibutyl and diamyl sulfates; long chain halides such as, but not limited to, decyl, lauryl, myristyl and stearyl chlorides, bromides and iodides; arylalkyl halides like benzyl and phenethyl bromides and others. Water or oil-soluble or dispersible products are thereby obtained. Examples of acids which can be employed to form pharmaceutically acceptable acid addition salts include such inorganic acids as hydrochloric acid, hydrobromic acid, sulfuric acid, and phosphoric acid and such organic acids as acetic acid, fumaric acid, maleic acid, 4-methylbenzenesulfonic acid, succinic acid and citric acid.
- Basic addition salts can be prepared in situ during the final isolation and purification of compounds of this invention by reacting a carboxylic acid-containing moiety with a suitable base such as, but not limited to, the hydroxide, carbonate or bicarbonate of a pharmaceutically acceptable metal cation or with ammonia or an organic primary, secondary or tertiary amine. Pharmaceutically acceptable salts include, but are not limited to, cations based on alkali metals or alkaline earth metals such as, but not limited to, lithium, sodium, potassium, calcium, magnesium and aluminum salts and the like and nontoxic quaternary ammonia and amine cations including ammonium, tetramethylammonium, tetraethylammonium, methylammonium, dimethylammonium, trimethylammonium, triethylammonium, diethylammonium, ethylammonium and the like. Other representative organic amines useful for the formation of base addition salts include ethylenediamine, ethanolamine, diethanolamine, piperidine, piperazine and the like.
- The compounds of the present invention can exist in unsolvated as well as solvated forms, including hydrated forms, such as hemi-hydrates. In general, the solvated forms, with pharmaceutically acceptable solvents such as water and ethanol among others are equivalent to the unsolvated forms for the purposes of the invention.
- The following examples serve to explain the invention without limiting it.
- The compounds were either characterized via proton-NMR in d6-dimethylsulfoxide, d-chloroform or d4-methanol on a 400 MHz, 500 MHz or 600 MHz NMR instrument (Bruker AVANCE), or by 13C-NMR at 125 MHz, or by 19F-NMR at 470 MHz, or by mass spectrometry, generally recorded via HPLC-MS in a fast gradient on C18-material (electrospray-ionisation (ESI) mode).
- The magnetic nuclear resonance spectral properties (NMR) refer to the chemical shifts (δ) expressed in parts per million (ppm). The relative area of the shifts in the 1H-NMR spectrum corresponds to the number of hydrogen atoms for a particular functional type in the molecule. The nature of the shift, as regards multiplicity, is indicated as singlet(s), broad singlet (s. br.), doublet (d), broad doublet (d br.), triplet (t), broad triplet (t br.), quartet (q), quintet (quint.), multiplet (m), doublet of doublets (dd), doublet of doublets of doublets (ddd), triplet of doublets (td), doublet of triplets of doublets (dtd), quartet of doublets of doublets (qdd) etc.
- Enantiomers were separated/purified by chiral supercritical fluid chromatography (SFC) (method A).
- Method A
- A.1 Analytical SFC
- Analytical samples were run on an Agilent 1260 Infinity Hybrid SFC System, controlled by Agilent OpenLab CDS ChemStation Edition. The system consists of an injector, a heated column compartment including a switch for 6 columns, a CO2-booster pump, a binary pump module for CO2 and modifier flow and an UV-detector. The backpressure regulator was set to 160 bars and heated to 60° C. If not stated otherwise, the columns were 100 mm in length, 4.6 mm in diameter and packed with 5 μm material. They were kept at room temperature during analysis. As mobile phase, a mixture of liquefied CO2 and organic modifier with additive was used as indicated for each sample. The flow rate was kept at 3.5 mL/min.
- A.2 Preparative SFC
- Preparative separations were carried out on a Waters Prep 100q SFC System, controlled by Waters MassLynx Software. The system consists of an open bed injector/collector, a heated column compartment including a switch for 6 columns, a CO2-booster pump, a pump module for modifier flow and an UV-detector. To enable quantitative collection, the gas liquid separator was driven with a make-up flow of 30 mL/min Methanol. The backpressure regulator was not to 120 bar and heated to 60° C. If not stated otherwise, the columns were 250 mm in length, 20 mm in diameter and packed with 5 μm material. They were kept at 30° C. during the separation. As mobile phase, a mixture of liquefied CO2 and organic modifier with additive was used as indicated for each sample. The flow rate was kept at 100 g/min.
- Abbreviations:
- h hour(s)
- min minute(s)
- d day(s)
- r.t. room temperature (20-25° C.)
- PE petroleum ether
- EtOH ethanol
- MeOH methanol
- DCM dichloromethane
- DCE dichloroethane
- THF tetrahydrofuran
- DMF N,N-dimethylformamide
- MeCN acetonitrile
- EtOAc ethyl acetate
- TFA trifluoroacetic acid
- DIPEA diisopropylethyl amine
- EDC 1-ethyl-3-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)carbodiimide
- HOBt hydroxybenzotriazole
- I. Preparation Examples
- In a 5 mL microwave vial containing 100 mg of ethyl (E)-4,4,4-trifluorobut-2-enoate (0.595 mmol, 1.00 eq), 163 mg of 2-aminophenyl boronic ester (1.19 mmol, 2.00 eq), 164 mg of potassium carbonate (1.19 mmol, 2.00 eq) and 13.6 mg of [RhOH(COD)]2 (0.030 mmol, 0.05 eq) was added 2% wt. TPGS-750-M solution in water (3 mL) (TPGS-750-M: a surfactant composed of a lipophilic α-tocopherol moiety and a hydrophilic PEG-750-M chain, joined by a succinic acid linker; forms spontaneously micelles upon dissolution in water. From Sigma-Aldrich.). The mixture was stirred vigorously at ambient temperature for 48 h. The reaction mixture was then extracted with ethyl acetate. Then the organic phase was dried over MgSO4, filtrated and reduced under vacuum. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-10% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound (116 mg, 82% yield).
- 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3): δ 9.05 (s, 1H), 7.32 (td, J=7.7, 1.5 Hz, 1H), 7.29 (d, J=7.5 Hz, 1H), 7.08 (td, J=7.6, 1.2 Hz, 1H), 6.90 (dd, J=8.0, 1.2 Hz, 1H), 3.64 (qdd, J=9.6, 7.1., 2.9 Hz, 1H), 3.00-2.89 (m, 2H).
- 13C NMR (125 MHz, CDCl3): δ 168.39, 137.83, 130.38, 130.08, 126.12 (q, J=281.0 Hz), 123.43, 116.30, 115.57, 41.15 (q, J=28.6 Hz), 30.07 (q, J=2.8 Hz).
- 19F NMR (470 MHz, CDCl3): δ −72.51.
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 216.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- 197 mg of 4-(trifluoromethyl)-3,4-dihydroquinolin-2(1H)-one from step 1.1 (0.916 mmol, 1.00 eq) was dissolved in 10 mL of THF (anhydrous) and 2.29 mL borane dimethyl sulfide complex (2 M in THF, 4.58 mmol, 5.00 eq) was slowly added. The mixture was heated in a microwave at 90° C. for 8 h. Then the reaction mixture was quenched with HCl (1 M) and the aqueous phase was extracted with ethyl acetate. Subsequently the organic phase was extracted three times with HCl (1M) and to the aqueous phase was added NaOH (1M) until pH 10. The mixture was then extracted with dichloromethane three times. The organic phase was dried over MgSO4 and reduced under vacuum. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-10% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound (114 mg, 62% yield).
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 202.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- A mixture of 114 mg of 4-(trifluoromethyl)-1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinoline from step 1.2 (0.567 mmol, 1.00 eq), 210 mg of 2-iodoacetamide (1.13 mmol, 2.00 eq) and 0.385 ml of DIPEA (2.27 mmol, 4.00 eq) in DMF (3 mL) was heated in a microwave at 130° C. for 8 h. Then NaOH (1M) was added and the mixture was extracted with dichloromethane. The organic phase was dried over MgSO4 and reduced under vacuum. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-10% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound (86 mg, 59% yield).
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 259.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- 86 mg of 2-(4-(trifluoromethyl)-3,4-dihydroquinolin-1(2H)-yl)acetamide from step 1.3 (0.333 mmol, 1.00 eq) was dissolved in 3 mL THF (anhydrous) and 0.833 mL of borane dimethyl sulfide complex (2 M THF, 1.67 mmol, 5.00 eq) was slowly added. The mixture was heated in a microwave at 90° C. for 5 h. Then the reaction mixture was quenched with HCl (1 M) and the aqueous phase was extracted with ethyl acetate. Subsequently the organic phase was extracted three times with HCl (1M) and to the aqueous phase was added NaOH (1M) until pH 10. The mixture was then extracted with dichloromethane three times. The organic phase was dried over MgSO4 and reduced under vacuum. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-10% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound (69 mg, 85% yield).
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 245.15 (100, [M+H]+).
- A mixture of 69 mg of 2-(4-(trifluoromethyl)-3,4-dihydroquinolin-1(2H)-yl)ethanamine from step 1.4 (0.282 mmol, 1.00 eq), 0.022 mL of formaldehyde (0.282 mmol, 1.00 eq), and 0.022 mL of TFA (0.282 mmol, 1.00 eq) in ethanol (2 mL) was stirred for 3 d at ambient temperature. Then NaOH (1M) was added and the mixture was extracted with dichloromethane. The organic phase was dried over MgSO4 and reduced under vacuum. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-10% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound (47 mg, 65% yield).
- 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3) δ 7.17 (d, J=7.4 Hz, 1H), 7.09 (dd, J=7.5, 1.6 Hz, 1H), 6.81 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 1H), 3.98 (d, J=14.4 Hz, 1H), 3.85 (d, J=14.5 Hz, 1H), 3.49 (qdd, J=9.8, 6.1, 3.8 Hz, 1H), 3.31 (ddd, J=10.1, 3.6, 1.4 Hz, 2H), 3.17-3.01 (m, 4H), 2.20 (dq, J=14.2, 4.0 Hz, 1H), 2.10-1.97 (m, 2H).
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 257.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- The separation was carried out in two steps via method A.
- Two peaks were separated on a Daicel Chiralpak® AS-H column (150×4.6 mm, 5 μm) (tR [min]=1.4, 1.7). The gradient used holds at 95% CO2 and 5% modifier for 1 min. During 7 mins, it raises up to 50% modifier, which is then held for 1 min. Afterwards, the modifier is ramped back to 5% over 1 min (10 min total). As modifier, MeOH with 0.1 Vol % of diethylamine was used.
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 257.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- The retention time according to the method described above is 1.4 min.
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 257.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- The retention time according to the method described above is 1.7 min.
- In a 5 mL microwave vial containing ethyl (E)-5,5,5-trifluoropent-2-enoate (100 mg, 0.549 mmol, 1.00 eq), 2-aminophenyl boronic ester (150 mg, 1.10 mmol, 2.00 eq), potassium carbonate (152 mg, 1.10 mmol), 2.00 eq) and [RhOH(COD)]2 (12.52 mg, 0.027 mmol, 0.05 eq) was added 2% wt. TPGS-750-M solution in water (3 mL). The mixture was stirred vigorously at ambient temperature for 24 h. The reaction mixture was then extracted with ethyl acetate. Then the organic phase was dried over MgSO4, filtrated and reduced under vacuum. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-10% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound (94 mg, 75% yield).
- 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3): δ 9.28 (s, 1H), 7.28-7.17 (m, 2H), 7.05 (td, J=7.5, 1.2 Hz, 1H), 6.92-6.86 (m, 1H), 3.40 (dq, J=9.1, 5.0 Hz, 1H), 2.84 (dd, J=16.4, 5.9 Hz, 1H), 2.71 (dd, J=16.4, 3.6 Hz, 1H), 2.47-2.32 (m, 2H).
- 13C NMR (125 MHz, CDCl3): δ 170.43, 136.39, 128.62, 127.67, 126.20 (q, J=277.0 Hz), 124.94, 123.67, 116.23, 37.82 (q, J=27.6 Hz), 35.80, 30.96.
- 19F NMR (470 MHz, CDCl3): δ −63.33 (t, J=10.6 Hz).
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 230.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- 229 mg of 4-(2,2,2-trifluoroethyl)-3,4-dihydroquinolin-2(1H)-one from step 2.1 (0.999 mmol, 1.00 eq) was dissolved in 10 mL of THF (anhydrous) and 2.50 mL of borane dimethyl sulfide complex (2 M THF, 5.00 mmol, 5.00 eq) was slowly added. The mixture was heated in a microwave at 90° C. for 8 h. Then the reaction mixture was quenched with HCl (1 M) and the aqueous phase was extracted with ethyl acetate. Subsequently the organic phase was extracted three times with HCl (1M) and to the aqueous phase was added NaOH (1M) until pH 10. This was then extracted with dichloromethane three times. The organic phase was dried over MgSO4 and reduced under vacuum. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-10% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound (170 mg, 79% yield).
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 216.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- A mixture of 170 mg of 4-(2,2,2-trifluoroethyl)-1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinoline from step 2.2 (0.790 mmol, 1.00 eq), 292 mg of 2-iodoacetamide (1.58 mmol, 2.00 eq) and 0.537 mL of DIPEA (3.16 mmol, 4.00 eq) in DMF (3 mL) was heated in a microwave at 110° C. for 8 h and further 3 h at 130° C. Then NaOH (1M) was added and the mixture was extracted with dichloromethane. The organic phase was dried over MgSO4 and reduced under vacuum. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-10% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound (168 mg, 78% yield).
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 273.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- 165 mg of 2-(4-(2,2,2-trifluoroethyl)-3,4-dihydroquinolin-1(2H)-yl)acetamide from step 2.2 (0.606 mmol, 1.00 eq) was dissolved in 4 mL of THF (anhydrous) and 0.61 mL of borane dimethyl sulfide complex (2 M THF, 1.212 mmol, 2.00 eq) was slowly added. The mixture was heated in a microwave at 90° C. for 2 h. Then the reaction mixture was quenched with HCl (1 M) and the aqueous phase was extracted with ethyl acetate. Subsequently the organic phase was extracted three times with HCl (1M) and to the aqueous phase was added NaOH (1M) until pH 10. This was then extracted with dichloromethane three times. The organic phase was dried over MgSO4 and reduced under vacuum. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-10% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound (90 mg, 52% yield).
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 259.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- A mixture of 90 mg of 2-(4-(2,2,2-trifluoroethyl)-3,4-dihydroquinolin-1(2H)-yl)ethanamine from step 2.3 (0.314 mmol, 1.00 eq), 23 μL of formaldehyde (0.314 mmol, 1.00 eq) and 27 μL of TFA (0.314 mmol, 1.00 eq) was stirred at ambient temperature for 72 h. Then NaOH (1M) was added and the mixture was extracted with dichloromethane. The organic phase was dried over MgSO4 and reduced under vacuum. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-10% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound (62 mg, 72% yield).
- 1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 7.01 (dd, J=7.7, 1.5 Hz, 1H), 6.95 (dd, J=7.3, 1.6 Hz, 1H), 6.72 (t, J=7.4 Hz, 1H), 3.72 (d, J=14.1 Hz, 1H), 3.64 (d, J=14.1 Hz, 1H), 3.21-3.17 (m, 2H), 3.13-3.07 (m, 1H), 3.03-2.96 (m, 2H), 2.93-2.83 (m, 2H), 1.81-1.73 (m, 1H), 3.47-3.43 (m, 1H), 2.67-2.51 (m, 2H), 1.92-1.83 (m, 1H).
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 271.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- In a 5 mL microwave vial containing ethyl (E)-4,4-difluorobut-2-enoate (110 mg, 0.67 mmol, 1.00 eq), 2-aminophenyl boronic ester (183 mg, 1.33 mmol, 2.00 eq), potassium carbonate (184 mg, 1.33 mmol), 2.00 eq) and [RhOH(COD)]2 (15 mg, 0.033 mmol, 0.05 eq) was added 2% wt. TPGS-750-M solution in water (3 mL). The mixture was stirred vigorously at ambient temperature for the 24 h. The reaction mixture was then extracted with ethyl acetate. Then the organic phase was dried over MgSO4, filtrated and reduced under vacuum. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-10% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound (70 mg, 50% yield).
- 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3): δ 9.05 (s, 1H), 7.27 (dtd, J=15.4, 7.7, 1.4 Hz, 2H), 7.06 (td, J=7.5, 1.1 Hz, 1H), 6.88 (dd, J=7.9, 1.2 Hz, 1H), 5.85 (td, J=56.0, 4.3 Hz, 1H), 5.74 (d, J=4.3 Hz, 1H), 3.44-3.33 (m, 1H), 2.94-2.82 (m, 2H).
- 13C NMR (125 MHz, CDCl3): δ 169.41, 137.65, 129.55, 129.46, 123.48, 117.92 (t, J=3.8 Hz), 116.26 (t, J=245.4 Hz), 116.12, 40.95 (t, J=22.1 Hz), 29.64.
- 19F NMR (470 MHz, CDCl3): δ −120.87 (ddd, J=280.0, 55.9, 13.4 Hz), −123.60 (ddd, J=280.1, 56.2, 16.5 Hz).
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 198.10 (100, [M+H]+).
- 390 mg of 4-(difluoromethyl)-3,4-dihydroquinolin-2(1H)-one from step 3.1 (1.98 mmol, 1.00 eq) was dissolved in 4 mL of THF (anhydrous) and 3.96 mL of borane dimethyl sulfide complex (2 M in THF, 7.92 mmol, 4.00 eq) was slowly added. The mixture was heated in a microwave at 90° C. for 10 h. Then the reaction mixture was quenched with HCl (1 M) and the aqueous phase was extracted with ethyl acetate. Subsequently the organic phase was extracted three times with HCl (1M) and to the aqueous phase was added NaOH (1M) until pH 10. This was then extracted with dichloromethane three times. The organic phase was dried over MgSO4 and reduced under vacuum. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-10% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound (220 mg, 55% yield).
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 184.10 (100, [M+H]+).
- A mixture of 220 mg of 4-(difluoromethyl)-1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinoline from step 3.2 (1.20 mmol, 1.00 eq), 666 mg of 2-iodoacetamide (3.60 mmol, 3.00 eq) and 1 mL of DIPEA (6.00 mmol, 500 eq) in DMF (3 mL) was heated in a microwave at 100° C. for 11 h. Then NaOH (1M) was added and the mixture was extracted with dichloromethane. The organic phase was dried over MgSO4 and reduced under vacuum. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-10% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound (260 mg, 90% yield).
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 241.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- 260 mg of 2-(4-(difluoromethyl)-3,4-dihydroquinolin-1(2H)-yl)acetamide from step 3.3 (1.08 mmol, 1.00 eq) was dissolved in 3 mL of THF (anhydrous) and 2.71 mL of borane dimethyl sulfide complex (2 M in THF, 5.41 mmol, 5.00 eq) was slowly added. The mixture was heated in a microwave at 90° C. for 5 h. Then the reaction mixture was quenched with HCl (1 M) and the aqueous phase was extracted with ethyl acetate. Subsequently the organic phase was extracted three times with HCl (1M) and to the aqueous phase was added NaOH (1M) until pH 10. This was then extracted with dichloromethane three times. The organic phase was dried over MgSO4 and reduced under vacuum. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-10% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound (155 mg, 57% yield).
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 227.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- A mixture of 155 mg of 2-(4-(difluoromethyl)-3,4-dihydroquinolin-1(2H)-yl)ethanamine from step 3.4 (0.685 mmol, 1.00 eq), 0.055 mL of formaldehyde (0.719 mmol, 1.05 eq), and 0.058 mL of TFA (0.754 mmol, 1.10 eq) in ethanol (2 mL) was stirred for 7 h at ambient temperature. Then NaOH (1M) was added and the mixture was extracted with dichloromethane. The organic phase was dried over MgSO4 and reduced under vacuum. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-20% methanol in dichloromethane+0.1% NH3 in ethanol) to yield the title compound (51 mg, 26% yield).
- 1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 8.83 (s, 1H), 7.34-7.21 (m, 2H), 6.91 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 1H), 6.35 (td, J=56.1, 4.2 Hz, 1H), 4.18 (dt, J=24.4, 4.4 Hz, 2H), 3.31-3.20 (m, 7H), 2.02-1.83 (m, 2H).
- ESI-MS: (%): 239.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- A mixture of 1.57 g of 4-(trifluoromethyl-1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinoline (7.80 mmol, 1.00 eq) from step 1.2, 14.1 g of ethyl 2-bromopropanoate (78.0 mmol, 10.0 eq and 15.1 mL of DIPEA (117 mmol, 15.0 eq) in DMF (38 mL) was heated in a microwave for 1 h at 175° C. Then the mixture was diluted with ethyl acetate and washed with aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution. The aqueous phase was extracted three times with ethyl acetate and the combined organic phases were dried over Na2SO4, filtrated and concentrated in vacuum. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-30% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound.
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 302.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- A mixture of 2.59 g of ethyl 2-(4-(trifluoromethyl)-3,4-dihydroquinolin-1(2H)-yl)propanoate (8.60 mmol, 1.00 eq) from step 4.1 and 43.0 mL of NaOH (1M in H2O, 43.0 mmol, 5.00 eq) in MeOH (40 mL) was stirred at room temperature for 16 h. Then saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution was added and the mixture was washed with ethyl acetate. 1M HCl was added to the aqueous phase until pH 3 was reached. The aqueous phase was extracted 5 times with DCM and the organic phase was dried over Na2SO4, filtrated and concentrated in vacuum to yield the title compound (47%, 4.02 mmol).
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 274.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- To a solution of 1.10 g of 2-(4-(trifluoromethyl)-3,4-dihydroquinolin-1(2H)-yl)propanoic acid (4.02 mmol, 1.00 eq) from step 4.2, 430 mg of ammonium chloride (8.04 mmol, 2.00 eq) and 0.702 mL of DIPEA (4.02 mmol, 1.00 eq) in DMF (20 mL) was added 1.54 g of EDC (8.04 mmol, 2.00 eq) and 616 mg HOBt (4.02 mmol, 1.00 eq) and the mixture was stirred for 16 h at room temperature. Then DCM was added and the mixture was washed with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution. The organic layer was dried over Na2SO4, filtrated and reduced under vacuum. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-30% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound (86%, 3.46 mmol).
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 273.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- To 942 mg of 2-(4-(trifluoromethyl)-3,4-dihydroquinolin-1(2H)-yl)propanamide (3.46 mmol, 1.00 eq) from step 4.3 and 8.65 mL of borane dimethyl sulfide complex (1 M in THF, 17.3 mmol, 5.00 eq) was slowly added. The mixture was stirred for 72 h at room temperature and was then heated at 90° C. for 2 h. Then the reaction mixture was quenched with HCl (1 M) and the aqueous phase was extracted with ethyl acetate. The organic phase was extracted three times with HCl (1M) and to the aqueous phase was added NaOH (1M) until pH 10 and was then extracted with dichloromethane three times. The organic phase was dried over MgSO4 and reduced under vacuum. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-30% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound (1.68 mmol, 49%).
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 259.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- A mixture of 444 mg of 2-(4-(trifluoromethyl)-3,4-dihydroquinolin-1(2H)-yl)propan-1-amine (1.72 mmol, 1.00 eq) from step 4.4, 0.128 mL of formaldehyde (1.72 mmol, 1.00 eq) and 0.146 mL of TFA (1.89 mmol, 1.10 eq) was stirred at ambient temperature for 72 h. Then the solvent was removed under vacuum. The residue was dissolved with DCM and washed with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution. The organic layer was dried over Na2SO4, filtrated and reduced under vacuum. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-30% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound (40%, 0.688 mmol).
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 271.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- Four peaks were separated on a Daicel Chiralcel® OD-H column (tR [min]=1.5, 1.7, 1.9, 2.2). The mobile phase consisted of 93% CO2 and 7% modifier. As modifier, MeOH with 0.2 Vol % of aqueous ammonia solution (25%) was used.
- All 4 Isomers were separated in one step by UV-detection at 254 nm:
- Four peaks were separated on a Daicel Chiralcel® OD-H column (250×20 mm, 5 μm) (tR [min]=4.6, 5.1, 6.1, 6.6). The mobile phase consisted of 95% CO2 and 5% modifier. As modifier, MeOH with 0.2 Vol % of aqueous ammonia solution (25%) was used.
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 271.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- The retention time according to the analytical method described above is 1.5 min and according to the preparative method described above is 4.6 min.
- 1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl3): δ 7.20 (d, J=8.0, 1.8 Hz, 1H), 7.10-7.06 (m, 1H), 6.82 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 1H), 3.98 (d, J=13.6 Hz, 1H), 3.74 (d, J=13.7 Hz, 1H), 3.53-3.42 (m, 1H), 3.42-3.34 (m, 1H), 3.34-3.24 (m, 2H), 3.12 (dd, J=13.5, 2.6 Hz, 1H), 2.81 (dd, J=13.5, 3.8 Hz, 1H), 2.19-2.02 (m, 2H), 1.07 (d, J=6.8 Hz, 3H). (NH not detected)
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 271.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- The retention time according to the analytical method described above is 1.7 min and according to the preparative method described above is 5.1 min.
- 1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl3): δ 7.21 (d, J=7.8 Hz, 1H), 7.11-7.07 (m, 1H), 6.82 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 1H), 4.00 (d, J=13.6 Hz, 1H), 3.76 (d, J=13.6 Hz, 1H), 3.53-3.45 (m, 1H), 3.40-3.34 (m, 1H), 3.34-3.25 (m, 2H), 3.13 (dd, J=13.6, 2.6 Hz, 1H), 2.83 (dd, J=13.5, 3.8 Hz, 1H), 2.18-2.02 (m, 2H), 1.10 (d, J=6.8 Hz, 3H). (NH not detected)
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 271.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- The retention time according to the analytical method described above is 1.9 min and according to the preparative method described above is 6.1 min.
- 1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl3): δ 7.19 (d, J=7.7 Hz, 1H), 7.13 (dd, J=7.5, 1.6 Hz, 1H), 6.82 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 1H), 4.11 (d, J=14.0 Hz, 1H), 3.70 (d, J=14.0 Hz, 1H), 3.45 (dt, J=9.8, 5.3 Hz, 1H), 3.36 (td, J=6.7, 3.4 Hz, 2H), 3.31 (ddd, J=12.5, 3.7, 1.4 Hz, 1H), 3.08 (dd, J=13.6, 2.7 Hz, 1H), 3.02 (dd, J=13.5, 3.2 Hz, 1H), 2.33-2.14 (m, 1H), 2.06-1.92 (m, 1H), 1.00 (d, J=6.8 Hz, 3H). (NH not detected)
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 271.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- The retention time according to the analytical method described above is 2.2 min and according to the preparative method described above is 6.6 min.
- 1H NMR (600 MHz, CDCl3): δ 7.15 (d, J=7.8 Hz, 1H), 7.09 (dd, J=7.4, 1.6 Hz, 1H), 6.79 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 1H), 4.03 (d, J=14.1 Hz, 1H), 3.62 (d, J=14.2 Hz, 1H), 3.49-3.40 (m, 1H), 3.39-3.25 (m, 3H), 3.05 (dd, J=13.7, 2.7 Hz, 1H), 2.93 (dd, J=13.6, 3.1, 0.9 Hz, 1H), 2.26 (dq, J=14.3, 3.6 Hz, 1H), 2.06-1.92 (m, 1H), 0.92 (d, J=6.9 Hz, 3H). (NH not detected)
- A mixture of 416 mg of 4-(difluoromethyl)-1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinoline (2.27 mmol, 1.00 eq) from step 3.2, 4.11 g of ethyl 2-bromopropanoate (22.7 mmol, 10.0 eq and 5.95 mL DIPEA (34.1 mmol, 15.0 eq) in DMF (10 mL) was heated in a microwave for 1 h at 150° C. Then the mixture was diluted with ethyl acetate and washed with aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution. The aqueous phase was extracted three times with ethyl acetate and the combined organic phases were dried over Na2SO4, filtrated and concentrated in vacuum. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-30% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound.
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 284.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- A mixture of 1.07 g of ethyl 2-(4-(difluoromethyl)-3,4-dihydroquinolin-1(2H)-yl)propanoate (3.78 mmol, 1.00 eq) from step 5.1 and 18.9 mL of NaOH (1M in H2O, 18.9 mmol, 5.00 eq) MeOH (20 mL) was stirred at room temperature for 16 h. Then saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution was added and the mixture was washed with ethyl acetate. 1M HCl was added to the aqueous phase until pH 3 was reached. The aqueous phase was extracted 5 times with DCM and the organic phase was dried over Na2SO4, filtrated and concentrated in vacuum to yield the title compound (55%, 2.06 mmol).
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 256.30 (100, [M+H]+).
- To a solution of 526 mg of 2-(4-(difluoromethyl)-3,4-dihydroquinolin-1(2H)-yl)propanoic acid (2.06 mmol, 1.00 eq) from step 5.2, 220 mg of ammonium chloride (4.12 mmol, 2.00 eq) and 0.360 mL of DIPEA (2.06 mmol, 1.00 eq) in DMF (10 mL) was added 789 mg of EDC (4.12 mmol, 2.00 eq) and 315 mg of HOBt (2.06 mmol, 1.00 eq) and the mixture was stirred for 16 h at room temperature. Then DCM was added and the mixture was washed with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution. The organic layer was dried over Na2SO4, filtrated and reduced under vacuum. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-30% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound (64%, 1.31 mmol).
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 255.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- To 333 mg of 2-(4-(difluoromethyl)-3,4-dihydroquinolin-1(2H)-yl)propanamide (1.31 mmol, 1.00 eq) from step 5.3 and 6.54 mL of borane dimethyl sulfide complex (1 M in THF, 6.54 mmol, 5.00 eq) was slowly added. The mixture was stirred for 72 h at room temperature and was then heated in a microwave at 90° C. for 30 min. The reaction mixture was quenched with HCl (1 M) and the aqueous phase was extracted with ethyl acetate. The organic phase was extracted three times with HCl (1M) and to the aqueous phase was added NaOH (1M) until pH 10 and was then extracted with dichloromethane three times. The organic phase was dried over MgSO4 and reduced under vacuum. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-30% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound (0.720 mmol, 55%).
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 241.25 (100, [M+H]+).
- A mixture of 173 mg of 2-(4-(difluoromethyl)-3,4-dihydroquinolin-1(2H)-yl)propan-1-amine (0.720 mmol, 1.00 eq) from step 5.4, formaldehyde (0.720 mmol, 1.00 eq) and TFA (0.792 mmol, 1.10 eq) was stirred at ambient temperature for 72 h. Then the solvent was removed under vacuum. The residue was dissolved with DCM and washed with saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution. The organic layer was dried over Na2SO4, filtrated and reduced under vacuum. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-30% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound (45%, 0.326 mmol).
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 253.25 (100, [M+H]+).
- 1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ 7.11 (d, J=7.6 Hz, 1H), 6.99 (dd, J=1.5 Hz, 1H), 6.74 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 1H), 6.29 (td, J=56.2, 4.1 Hz, 1H), 3.80 (d, J=13.4 Hz, 1H), 3.47 (d, J=13.4 Hz, 1H), 3.40-3.31 (m, 1H), 3.30-3.21 (m, 2H), 3.21-3.16 (m, 1H), 2.85 (dd, J=13.2, 2.6 Hz, 1H), 2.68 (dd, J=13.1, 3.5 Hz, 1H), 1.98-1.89 (m, 1H), 1.89-1.80 (m, 1H), 0.91 (d, J=6.7 Hz, 3H). (NH not detected)
- Three peaks were separated on a Daicel Chiralcel® OD-H column (tR [min]=1.9, 2.1, 2.5). The mobile phase consisted of 93% CO2 and 7% modifier. As modifier, MeOH with 0.2 Vol % of aqueous ammonia solution (25%) was used.
- The second peak could be further separated on a Daicel Chiralpak® AD-H column (tR [min]=1.8, 2.1). The mobile phase consisted of 93% CO2 and 7% modifier. As modifier, MeOH with 0.2 Vol % of aqueous ammonia solution (25%) was used.
- The separation of the 4 isomers was carried out in two steps by UV-detection at 254 nm:
- Three peaks were separated on a Daicel Chiralcel® OD-H column (250×20 mm, 5 μm) (tR [min]=2.7, 3.2, 3.5). The mobile phase consisted of 90% CO2 and 10% modifier. As modifier, MeOH with 0.1 Vol % of triethylamine was used.
- The second peak consisted of two isomers, that were subsequently separated on a YMC CHIRAL Amylose-C column (250×20 mm, 5 μm) (tR [min]=3.9, 4.3). The mobile phase consisted of 93% CO2 and 7% modifier. As modifier, MeOH with 0.2 Vol % of aqueous ammonia solution (25%) was used.
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 253.25 (100, [M+H]+).
- The retention time according to the analytical method described above is 1.9 min and according to the preparative method described above is 2.7 min.
- 1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6): δ 7.11 (d, J=7.6 Hz, 1H), 6.99 (dd, J=7.3, 1.5 Hz, 1H), 6.74 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 1H), 6.29 (td, J=56.2, 4.1 Hz, 1H), 3.80 (d, J=13.4 Hz, 1H), 3.47 (d, J=13.4 Hz, 1H), 3.40-3.31 (m, 1H), 3.30-3.21 (m, 2H), 3.21-3.16 (m, 1H), 2.85 (dd, J=13.2, 2.6 Hz, 1H), 2.68 (dd, J=13.1, 3.5 Hz, 1H), 1.98-1.89 (m, 1H), 1.89-1.80 (m, 1H), 0.91 (d, J=6.7 Hz, 3H). (NH not detected)
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 253.25 (100, [M+H]+).
- The retention time according to the analytical method described above is 1.8 min and according to the preparative method described above is 3.9 min.
- 1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 7.04 (dd, J=7.7, 1.6 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (dd, J=7.3, 1.6 Hz, 1H), 6.70 (t, J=7.4 Hz, 1H), 6.27 (td, J=56.3, 4.8 Hz, 1H), 3.84 (d, J=13.5 Hz, 1H), 3.39 (d, J=13.6 Hz, 1H), 3.28-3.12 (m, 4H), 2.80 (dd, J=13.1, 2.5 Hz, 1H), 2.73 (dd, J=13.1, 3.1 Hz, 1H), 2.07-1.96 (m, 1H), 1.88-1.75 (m, 1H), 0.87 (d, J=6.7 Hz, 3H). (NH not detected)
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 253.25 (100, [M+H]+).
- The retention time according to the analytical method described above is 2.1 min and according to the preparative method described above is 4.3 min.
- 1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 7.12 (d, J=7.6 Hz, 1H), 7.00 (dd, J=7.3, 1.6 Hz, 1H), 6.75 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 1H), 6.29 (td, J=56.2, 4.1 Hz, 1H), 3.81 (d, J=13.4 Hz, 1H), 3.50 (d, J=13.4 Hz, 1H), 3.41-3.28 (m, 1H), 3.30-3.22 (m, 2H), 3.22-3.14 (m, 1H), 2.86 (dd, J=13.1, 2.6 Hz, 1H), 2.70 (dd, J=13.1, 3.5 Hz, 1H), 1.98-1.89 (m, 1H), 1.89-1.81 (m, 1H), 0.92 (d, J=6.7 Hz, 3H). (NH not detected)
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 253.25 (100, [M+H]+).
- The retention time according to the analytical method described above is 2.5 min and according to the preparative method described above is 3.5 min.
- 1H NMR (600 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 7.05 (dd, J=7.5, 1.6 Hz, 1H), 6.99 (dd, J=7.3, 1.6 Hz, 1H), 6.71 (t, J=7.4 Hz, 1H), 6.27 (td, J=56.4, 4.8 Hz, 1H), 3.85 (d, J=13.6 Hz, 1H), 3.41 (d, J=13.6 Hz, 1H), 3.28-3.09 (m, 4H), 2.81 (dd, J=13.1, 2.5 Hz, 1H), 2.75 (dd, J=13.1, 3.2 Hz, 1H), 2.07-1.96 (m, 1H), 1.86-1.75 (m, 1H), 0.88 (d, J=6.7 Hz, 3H). (NH not detected)
- 500 mg of 1-(2-amino-1-methyl-2-oxo-ethyl)-3,4-dihydro-2H-quinoline-4-carboxylic acid (2.014 mmol, 1.00 eq) was dissolved in 1 mL of THF (anhydrous) and 5.03 mL of borane dimethyl sulfide complex (2 M in THF, 10.07 mmol, 5.00 eq) was slowly added. The mixture was heated in a microwave at 90° C. for 2 h. Then the reaction mixture was quenched with HCl (1 M) and the aqueous phase was extracted with ethyl acetate. The organic phase was extracted three times with HCl (1M) and to the aqueous phase was added NaOH (1M) until pH 10 and was then extracted with dichloromethane three times. The organic phase was dried over MgSO4 and reduced under vacuum. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-10% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound.
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 221.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- A mixture of 61 mg of (1-(1-aminopropan-2-yl)-1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinolin-4-yl)methanol (0.277 mmol, 1.00 eq) obtained in step 6.1, formaldehyde (0.277 mmol, 1.00 eq) and TFA (0.305 mmol, 1.10 eq) was stirred at ambient temperature for 72 h. Then the solvent was removed under vacuum. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-10% methanol in dichloromethane) to yield the title compound as TFA-salt (62%, 0.171 mmol).
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 233.30 (100, [M+H]+).
- 487 mg of (4-methyl-2,3,4,6,7,8-hexahydro-1H-[1,4]diazepino[6,7,1-ij]quinolin-8-yl)methanol (2.096 mmol, 1.00 eq) from step 6.2 was dissolved in DCM (15 mL) and 0.585 mL of triethylamine (4.19 mmol, 2.00 eq) was added. Then 457 mg (2.096 mmol, 1.00 eq) of di-tert-butyldicarbonat was added and the mixture was stirred for 18 h at room temperature. Citric acid was added and the solution was stirred for 15 min. The organic phase was separated from the aqueous phase and the aqueous phase was extracted with DCM. The organic phase was dried over MgSO4 and reduced under vacuum to yield the title compound.
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 333.30 (100, [M+H]+).
- 269 mg of tert-butyl 8-(hydroxymethyl)-4-methyl-3,4,7,8-tetrahydro-1H-[1,4]diazepino[6,7,1-ij]quinoline-2(6H)-carboxylate (0.810 mmol, 1.00 eq) from step 7.1 dissolved in DCM (5 mL) was cooled to 0° C. and 0.226 mL of triethylamine (1.62 mmol, 2.00 eq) was added. Then 0.066 mL of methanesulfonyl chloride (0.850 mmol, 1.05 eq) was added and the mixture was stirred for 1 h at 0° C. Then it was warmed up to room temperature and stirred for further 16 h. After quenching with water the organic phase was separated from the aqueous phase and the aqueous phase was extracted with DCM. The organic phase was dried over MgSO4 and reduced under vacuum. The crude product was purified by column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-100% methanol in DCM) to yield the title compound (43%, 0.064 mmol).
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 411.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- To 54 mg of tert-butyl 4-methyl-8-(((methylsulfonyl)oxy)methyl)-3,4,7,8-tetrahydro-1H-[1,4]diazepino[6,7,1-ij]quinoline-2(6H)-carboxylate (0.132 mmol, 1.00 eq) from step 7.2 dissolved in tert-butanol (2 mL) was added 80 mg of caesium fluoride (0.526, 4.00 eq). The mixture was heated for 2 h in a microwave at 80° C. Then saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution was added. The organic phase was separated from the aqueous phase and the aqueous phase was extracted with DCM. The organic phase was dried over MgSO4 and reduced under vacuum to yield the title compound.
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 335.30 (100, [M+H]+).
- To a solution of 78 mg of tert-butyl 8-(fluoromethyl)-4-methyl-3,4,7,8-tetrahydro-1H-[1,4]diazepino[6,7,1-ij]quinoline-2(6H)-carboxylate (0.233 mmol, 1.00 eq) from step 7.3 in DCM (3 mL) was added 0.180 mL of trifluoroacetic acid (2.33 mmol, 10.00 eq) and the mixture was stirred for 3 d. Then the solvent was evaporated and the crude product was purified via column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-100% ethyl acetate in heptane) which yielded the title compound (4.5%,0.010 mmol).
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 235.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- 1H NMR (500 MHz, Methanol-d4): δ 7.27-7.25 (m, 1H), 7.19 (dd, J=7.4, 1.5 Hz, 1H), 6.94 (td, J=7.6, 2.5 Hz, 1H), 4.84-4.44 (m, 3H), 4.28 (dd, J=13.2, 9.3 Hz, 1H), 4.08 (dd, J=15.8, 13.1 Hz, 1H), 3.70-3.44 (m, 1H), 3.43-3.31 (m, 1H), 3.31-3.15 (m, 3H), 2.07-1.85 (m, 1H), 1.96-1.92 (m, 1H), 1.31-1.20 (m, 4H).
- A solution of 50 mg of (4-methyl-2,3,4,6,7,8-hexahydro-1H-[1,4]diazepino[6,7,1-ij]quinolin-8-yl)methanol (0.150 mmol, 1.00 eq) from step 6.2 in DMF (5 mL) was cooled to 0° C. Then 9.02 mg of sodium hydride (0.226 mmol, 1.50 eq) was added and the mixture was stirred for 1 h at 0° C. 28.1 mg iodoethane (0.180 mmol, 1.20 eq) was added and the mixture was stirred for 72 h at room temperature. Then the solvent was evaporated and the crude product was purified via preparative HPLC to yield the title compound.
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 361.50 (100, [M+H]+).
- To a solution of 23.2 mg of tert-butyl 8-(ethoxymethyl)-4-methyl-3,4,7,8-tetrahydro-1H-[1,4]diazepino[6,7,1-ij]quinoline-2(6H)-carboxylate (0.064 mmol, 1.00 eq) from step 8.1 in DCM (5 mL) was added 99.0 μL of TFA (1.29 mmol, 20 eq) and the mixture was stirred for 24 h at room temperature. Then the solvent was evaporated and the crude product was purified via prep-HPLC to yield the title compound (10%, 0.006 mmol).
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 261.20 (100, [M+H]+).
- 1H NMR (500 MHz, Methanol-d4): δ 7.36-7.20 (m, 1H), 7.16 (dd, J=7.4, 1.6 Hz, 1H), 6.91 (t, J=7.6 Hz, 1H), 4.28 (d, J=13.1 Hz, 1H), 4.11-3.99 (m, 1H), 3.72-3.60 (m, 1H), 3.63-3.44 (m, 4H), 3.33-3.16 (m, 4H), 3.08-2.99 (m, 1H), 2.05-1.92 (m, 1H), 1.92-1.80 (m, 1H), 1.27-1.13 (m, 6H).
- A solution of 50 mg of (4-methyl-2,3,4,6,7,8-hexahydro-1H-[1,4]diazepino[6,7,1-ij]quinolin-8-yl)methanol (0.150 mmol, 1.00 eq) from step 6.2 in DMF (5 mL) was cooled to 0° C. Then 9.02 mg of sodium hydride (0.226 mmol, 1.50 eq) was added and the mixture was stirred for 1 h at 0° C. 32.3 mg of iodomethane (0.226 mmol, 1.50 eq) was added and the mixture was stirred for 72 h at room temperature. Then the solvent was evaporated and the crude product was purified via column chromatography on silica (eluent: 0-40% methanol in DCM) which yielded the title compound (80%, 0.120 mmol).
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 347.30 (100, [M+H]+).
- To a solution of 41.6 mg of tert-butyl 8-(methoxymethyl)-4-methyl-3,4,7,8-tetrahydro-1H-[1,4]diazepino[6,7,1-ij]quinoline-2(6H)-carboxylate (0.120 mmol, 1.00 eq) from step 9.1 in DCM (5 mL) was added 185 μL of TFA (2.40 mmol, 20.0 eq) and the mixture was stirred for 24 h at room temperature. Then the solvent was evaporated and the crude product was purified via preparative HPLC to yield the title compound (19%, 0.023 mmol).
- ESI-MS: m/z (%): 247.30 (100, [M+H]+).
- 1H NMR (500 MHz, Methanol-d4): δ 1H NMR (500 MHz, Methanol-d4) δ 7.31-7.25 (m, 1H), 7.16 (dd, J=7.6, 1.6 Hz, 1H), 6.91 (t, J=7.6 Hz, 1H), 4.28 (d, J=13.2 Hz, 1H), 4.04 (d, J=13.2 Hz, 1H), 3.61-3.54 (m, 1H), 3.57-3.49 (m, 2H), 3.37 (s, 3H), 3.28-3.18 (m, 3H), 3.25-3.22 (m, 2H), 3.08-3.01 (m, 1H), 2.03-1.94 (m, 1H), 1.91-1.80 (m, 1H), 1.24 (d, J=7.0 Hz, 3H).
- II. Biological Tests
- Functional Activity
- 1. Human 5-HT2C Functional Assay
- The functional activity of compounds of formula I was assayed by incubation with U2OS_HTR2C _β-Arrestin cells (DiscoverX, 93-0289C3) to induce beta-arrestin2 recruitment to the 5-HT2C receptor. The agonist-induced recruitment and proximity of the receptor and beta-arrestin2 leads to complementation and formation of active β-galactosidase. The enzyme complementation results in enzyme activity, which is measured following the termination of the agonist incubation using DiscoveRx's detection reagent, which contains a chemiluminescent substrate which produces a high intensity signal. Cells were plated and a medium-change to a 1% serum containing medium was performed 24 h later. The next day, test compounds were added and incubated for 1.5 h before addition of detection reagent.
- The response produced was measured and compared with the response produced by 10 [mu]M 5-HT or the maximal effect induced by 5-HT (defined as 100%) to which it was expressed as a percentage response (relative efficacy). Dose response curves were constructed using Graphpad Prism (Graph Software Inc.) or using in house adapted software using a 4 parameter dose response model with variable slope (fit=(Bottom+(Top-Bottom)/(1+10̂((LogEC50-x)*HillSlope))res=(y-fit)). Results are compiled in the table below.
- 2. Human 5-HT2A Functional Assay
- Functional activity on the 5-HT2A receptor was determined by testing the effect of the compounds I on calcium mobilization in CHO-K1 cells, stably transfected with human 5-HT2A receptor. Cells were seeded into sterile black 384-well plates with clear bottom at 25,000 cells/well in a volume of 25 μl and grown for 5-6 hours at 37° C., in 5% CO2 in tissue culture medium (“Ultra CHO” by LONZA), containing 1% dialysed FCS and 50 μg/ml gentamicin (Invitrogen). After this incubation, medium was replaced by a serum free version of the same tissue culture medium followed by incubation overnight at 37° C. and in 5% CO2. Cells were then loaded with a fluorescent calcium-sensitive dye in the presence of 0.07% probenecid for an hour at 37° C., according to the manufacturer's protocol (Ca5-Assay Kit, Molecular Devices), followed by an additional 60 min incubation at room temperature. Serial compound dilutions (final concentrations of 10−10 to 10−5 M, prepared in HBSS+50 HEPES) were first added to the cells alone (“first addition” to assess agonism on the 5-HT2A receptor), then after 8 min, serotonin was added to the same wells at a final concentration of 3×10−8M (“second addition” to see potential antagonistic effect) and the maximal calcium response was determined using a FLIPR® Tetra instrument (Molecular Devices) in each of the two steps. The relative efficacy of the compounds was calculated as a percentage of the maximal effect induced by serotonin alone (defined as 100%). To determine EC50/IC50 values, concentration-response curves were fitted using a four-parameter logistic equation (IDBS Biobook™). Kb values were calculated from IC50 values, according to Cheng & Prusoff.
- 3. Human 5-HT2B Functional Assay
- Functional activity on the 5-HT2B receptor was determined by testing the effect of the compounds I on calcium mobilization in CHO-FlpIn cells, stably transfected with human 5-HT2B receptor. Cells were seeded into sterile black 384-well plates with clear bottom at 30,000 cells/well in a volume of 25 μl and grown overnight at 37° C., in 5% CO2 in tissue culture medium (“CHO-S-SFM II” by Invitrogen), containing 1% dialysed FCS and 50 μg/ml gentamicin (Invitrogen). On the next morning, medium was replaced by a serum free version of the same tissue culture medium for a further incubation for 4 hours at 37° C. and in 5% CO2. Cells were then loaded with a fluorescent calcium-sensitive dye in the presence of 0.07% probenecid for an hour at 37° C., according to the manufacturer's protocol (Ca5-Assay Kit, Molecular Devices), followed by an additional 60 min incubation at room temperature. Serial compound dilutions (final concentrations of 10−10 to 10−5M, prepared in HBSS+50 mM HEPES) were first added to the cells alone (“first addition” to assess agonism on the 5-HT2B receptor), then after 8 min, serotonin was added to the same wells at a final concentration of 10−8 M (“second addition” to see potential antagonistic effect) and the maximal calcium response was determined using a FLIPR® Tetra instrument (Molecular Devices) in each of the two steps. The relative efficacy of the compounds was calculated as a percentage of the maximal effect induced by serotonin alone (defined as 100%). To determine EC50/IC50 values, concentration-response curves were fitted using a four-parameter logistic equation (IDBS Biobook™). Kb values were calculated from IC50 values, according to Cheng & Prusoff.
-
TABLE Selec- EC50 % EC50 % Selectivity4 EC50 % tivity5 5- effi- 5- effi- (based on 5- effi- (based on # HT2C 1 cacy HT2A 2 cacy agonism) HT2B 3 cacy agonism) 1 ++ 85 * antagonist6 * antagonist 1.A ++ 57 * antagonist * antagonist 1.B ++ 88 * antagonist + 34 3 2 + 72 * full7 * antagonist 3 ++ 93 * antagonist * full 4 ++ 104 * antagonist * antagonist 4.A +++ 101 * antagonist * antagonist 4.B ++ 87 * antagonist * antagonist 4.C +++ 101 ++ 24 2 ++ 44 12 4.D + 86 * antagonist + 30 2 5 ++ 95 * antagonist * antagonist 5.A +++ 109 +++ 21 0.5 + 36 20 5.B ++ 110 * antagonist * antagonist 5.C + 89 * full * antagonist 5.D + 84 * full * antagonist 7 ++ 107 * antagonist * antagonist 8 + 93 * full * full 9 + 82 * full * full 1Potency (EC50 5-HT2C) in functional assay 2Potency (EC50 5-HT2A) in functional assay 3Potency (EC50 5-HT2B) in functional assay 4EC50 5-HT2A/EC50 5-HT2C 5EC50 5-HT2B/EC50 5-HT2C 6“antagonist” indicates functional antagonism with no measurable agonistic effect 7“full” indicates no measurable agonistic effect at 10 μM (highest concentration in assay) Potency (EC50): * >10 μM + from 200 nM to <1 μM ++ from 20 nM to <200 nM +++ <20 nM
Claims (24)
1.-39. (canceled)
40. A method for treating disorders which respond to the modulation of the 5-HT2c receptor comprising
administering to a subject in need thereof at least one compound of formula (I)
wherein
R1 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, cyano, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C2-C6-alkenyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkenyl, C2-C6-alkynyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkynyl, C3-C8-cycloalkyl, fluorinated C3-C8-cycloalkyl, C1-C6-alkoxy, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy, —C(═O)R9, phenyl, phenyl-C1-C2-alkyl and a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated heterocyclic ring containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom groups independently selected from N, O, S, NO, SO and SO2 and optionally also 1 or 2 C═O and/or C═S groups as ring members, where the cyclic moieties in the three last-mentioned radicals may be substituted with one or more substituents R10;
each R2 is independently selected from the group consisting of cyano, nitro, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C1-C6-hydroxyalkyl, C2-C6-alkenyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkenyl, C2-C6-alkynyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkynyl, C3-C8-cycloalkyl, fluorinated C3-C8-cycloalkyl, C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, —CH2NR11aR11b, —C(═O)R9,
phenyl, phenyl-C1-C2-alkyl, and a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated ring containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom groups independently selected from N, O, S, NO, SO, SO2, C═O and C═S as ring members, where the cyclic moieties in the six last-mentioned radicals may be substituted with one or more substituents R10; or
two radicals R2 bound to the same carbon atom, together with the carbon atom they are bound to, form a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated ring, where the ring may contain 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom-containing groups selected from O, S, N, SO, SO2, C═O and C═S as ring members, and where the ring may be substituted with one or more substituents R10;
R3a and R3b, independently of each other, are selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, cyano, nitro, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C1-C6-hydroxyalkyl, C2-C6-alkenyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkenyl, C2-C6-alkynyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkynyl, C3-C8-cycloalkyl, fluorinated C3-C8-cycloalkyl, C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl,
—CH2NR11aR11b, —C(═O)R9, phenyl, phenyl-C1-C2-alkyl, and a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated ring containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom groups independently selected from N, O, S, NO, SO, SO2, C═O and C═S as ring members, where the cyclic moieties in the six last-mentioned radicals may be substituted with one or more substituents R10;
R4a and R4b, independently of each other, are selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, cyano, nitro, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C1-C6-hydroxyalkyl, C2-C6-alkenyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkenyl, C2-C6-alkynyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkynyl, C3-C8-cycloalkyl, fluorinated C3-C8-cycloalkyl, C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl,
—CH2NR11aR11b, —C(═O)R9, phenyl, phenyl-C1-C2-alkyl, and a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated ring containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom groups independently selected from N, O, S, NO, SO, SO2, C═O and C═S as ring members, where the cyclic moieties in the six last-mentioned radicals may be substituted with one or more substituents R10; or
R4a and R4b form together a group ═O or ═S; or
R4a and R4b, together with the carbon atom they are bound to, form a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated ring, where the ring may contain 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom-containing groups selected from O, S, N, SO, SO2, C═O and C═S as ring members, and where the ring may be substituted with one or more substituents R10;
R5a and R5b, independently of each other, are selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, halogen, cyano, nitro, hydroxyl, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C1-C6-hydroxyalkyl, C2-C6-alkenyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkenyl, C2-C6-alkynyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkynyl, C3-C8-cycloalkyl, fluorinated C3-C8-cycloalkyl, C1-C6-alkoxy, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy, C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, C1-C6-hydroxyalkoxy, C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkoxy, C1-C6-alkylthio, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylthio, C1-C6-alkylsulfinyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylsulfinyl, C1-C6-alkylsulfonyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylsulfonyl, —NR11aR11b, —CH2NR11aR11b, —NR11aC(O)R9,
—C(═O)R9, SO2NR11aR11b, C1-C6-alkylcarbonyloxy, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylcarbonyloxy, phenyl, phenyl-C1-C2-alkyl, phenoxy, phenylsulfonyl, benzyloxy and a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated ring containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom groups independently selected from N, O, S, NO, SO, SO2, C═O and C═S as ring members, where the cyclic moieties in the six last-mentioned radicals may be substituted with one or more substituents R10; where R5a and R5b are not simultaneously hydroxyl; or
R5a and R5b, together with the carbon atom they are bound to, form a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated ring, where the ring may contain 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom-containing groups selected from O, S, N, SO, SO2, C═O and C═S as ring members, and where the ring may be substituted with one or more substituents R10;
R6 is C1-C6-alkyl which carries one or more substituents R8;
each R7 is independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, cyano, nitro, hydroxyl, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C1-C6-hydroxyalkyl, C2-C6-alkenyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkenyl, C2-C6-alkynyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkynyl, C3-C8-cycloalkyl, fluorinated C3-C8-cycloalkyl, C3-C8-cycloalkenyl, fluorinated C3-C8-cycloalkenyl, C1-C6-alkoxy, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy, C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, C1-C6-hydroxyalkoxy, C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkoxy, C1-C6-alkylthio, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylthio, C1-C6-alkylsulfinyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylsulfinyl, C1-C6-alkylsulfonyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylsulfonyl, —NR11aR11b, —CH2NR11aR11b, —NR11aC(O)R9, —C(═O)R9, SO2NR11aR11b, C1-C6-alkylcarbonyloxy, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylcarbonyloxy, phenyl, phenyl-C1-C2-alkyl, phenoxy, phenylsulfonyl, benzyloxy and a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated ring containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom groups independently selected from N, O, S, NO, SO, SO2, C═O and C═S as ring members, where the cyclic moieties in the six last-mentioned radicals may be substituted with one or more substituents R10; or
two radicals R7 bound on neighboring carbon atoms, together with the carbon atoms they are bound to, form a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated ring, where the ring may contain 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom-containing groups selected from O, S, N, SO, SO2, C═O and C═S as ring members, and where the ring may be substituted with one or more substituents R10;
each R8 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydroxyl, halogen, C1-C6-alkoxy, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy, C1-C6-hydroxyalkoxy, C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkoxy, C1-C6-alkylthio, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylthio, C1-C6-alkylsulfinyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylsulfinyl, C1-C6-alkylsulfonyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylsulfonyl and —NR11aR11b;
each R9 is independently selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, cyano, hydroxyl, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C1-C6-hydroxyalkyl, C2-C6-alkenyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkenyl, C2-C6-alkynyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkynyl, C3-C8-cycloalkyl, fluorinated C3-C8-cycloalkyl, C1-C6-alkoxy, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy, —NR11aR11b, —CH2NR11aR11b, phenyl, phenyl-C1-C2-alkyl, phenoxy, benzyloxy and a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated ring containing 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom groups independently selected from N, O, S, NO, SO, SO2, C═O and C═S as ring members, where the cyclic moieties in the five last-mentioned radicals may be substituted with one or more substituents R10;
each R10 is independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, cyano, nitro, hydroxyl, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C1-C6-hydroxyalkyl, C2-C6-alkenyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkenyl, C2-C6-alkynyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkynyl, C3-C8-cycloalkyl, fluorinated C3-C8-cycloalkyl, C1-C6-alkoxy, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy, C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkyl, C1-C6-hydroxyalkoxy, C1-C6-alkoxy-C1-C4-alkoxy, C1-C6-alkylthio, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylthio, C1-C6-alkylsulfinyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylsulfinyl, C1-C6-alkylsulfonyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylsulfonyl, —COOH, —NR11aR11b, —CH2NR11aR11b, C1-C6-alkylcarbonyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylcarbonyl, C1-C6-alkoxycarbonyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxycarbonyl, SO2NR11aR11b, C1-C6-alkylcarbonyloxy and fluorinated C1-C6-alkylcarbonyloxy;
or two radicals R10, together with the atom(s) they are bound to, form a saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated 3-, 4-, 5-, 6- or 7-membered carbocyclic or heterocyclic ring, where the heterocyclic ring contains 1, 2 or 3 heteroatoms or heteroatom groups independently selected from N, O, S, NO, SO, SO2, C═O and C═S as ring members;
R11a and R11b, independently of each other and independently of each occurrence, are selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, cyano, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C2-C6-alkenyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkenyl, C2-C6-alkynyl, fluorinated C2-C6-alkynyl, C3-C8-cycloalkyl, fluorinated C3-C8-cycloalkyl, C1-C6-alkoxy, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy, C1-C6-alkylcarbonyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkylcarbonyl, C1-C6-alkoxycarbonyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxycarbonyl, phenyl and benzyl, where the phenyl moieties in the two last-mentioned radicals may carry 1, 2 or 3 substituents selected from halogen, cyano nitro, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C1-C6-alkoxy and fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy; or,
if R11a and R11b are bound to the same nitrogen atom, together with this nitrogen atom may form a 3-, 4-, 5-, 6-, 7- or 8-membered saturated, partially unsaturated or maximally unsaturated heterocyclic ring, where the ring may further contain 1, 2, 3 or 4 heteroatoms or heteroatom-containing groups selected from O, S, N, SO, SO2, C═O and C═S as ring members, and where the ring may be substituted with one or more substituents selected from halogen, cyano nitro, C1-C6-alkyl, fluorinated C1-C6-alkyl, C1-C6-alkoxy and fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy;
a is 0, 1 or 2; and
b is 0, 1, 2 or 3;
or an N-oxide, a tautomeric form, a stereoisomer or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
41. The method as claimed in claim 40 , where the disorders are selected from the group consisting of damage of the central nervous system, disorders of the central nervous system, eating disorders, ocular hypertension, cardiovascular disorders, gastrointestinal disorders and diabetes.
42. The method as claimed in claim 41 , where the disorders are selected from the group consisting of bipolar disorder, depression, atypical depression, mood episodes, adjustment disorders, anxiety, panic disorders, post-traumatic syndrome, psychoses, schizophrenia, cognitive deficits of schizophrenia, memory loss, dementia of aging, Alzheimer's disease, neuropsychiatric symptoms in Alzheimer's disease, behavioral disorders associated with dementia, social phobia, mental disorders in childhood, attention deficit hyperactivity disorder, organic mental disorders, autism, mutism, disruptive behavior disorder, impulse control disorder, borderline personality disorder, obsessive compulsive disorder, migraine and other conditions associated with cephalic pain or other pain, raised intracranial pressure, seizure disorders, epilepsy, substance use disorders, alcohol abuse, cocaine abuse, tobacco abuse, smoking cessation, sexual dysfunction/erectile dysfunction in males, sexual dysfunction in females, premenstrual syndrome, late luteal phase syndrome, chronic fatigue syndrome, sleep disorders, sleep apnoea, chronic fatigue syndrome, psoriasis, Parkinson's disease, psychosis in Parkinson's disease, neuropsychiatric symptoms in Parkinson's disease, Lewy Body dementia, neuropsychiatric symptoms in Lewy Body dementia, spinal cord injury, trauma, stroke, pain, bladder dysfunction/urinary incontinence, encephalitis, meningitis, eating disorders, obesity, bulimia, weight loss, anorexia nervosa, ocular hypertension, cardiovascular disorders, gastrointestinal disorders, diabetes insipidus, diabetes mellitus, type I diabetes, type II diabetes, type III diabetes, diabetes secondary to pancreatic diseases, diabetes related to steroid use, diabetes complications, hyperglycemia and insulin resistance.
43. The method as claimed in claim 42 , where the disorders are selected from the group consisting of schizophrenia, depression, bipolar disorders, obesity, substance use disorders, neuropsychiatric symptoms in Alzheimer's disease and neuropsychiatric symptoms in Parkinson's disease.
44. The method as claimed in claim 40 , where R1 is hydrogen.
45. The method as claimed in claim 40 , where R2 is selected from methyl and CF3.
46. The method as claimed in claim 40 , where R3a and R3b are hydrogen.
47. The method as claimed in claim 40 , where R4a and R4b are hydrogen.
48. The method as claimed in claim 40 , where R5a is hydrogen or methyl and R5b is hydrogen
49. The method as claimed in claim 40 , where each R8 is independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, C1-C6-alkoxy and fluorinated C1-C6-alkoxy.
50. The method as claimed in claim 40 , where R6 is fluorinated C1-C2-alkyl.
51. The method as claimed in claim 40 , where R6 is fluorinated methyl.
52. The method as claimed in claim 40 , where R6 is CHF2 or CF3.
53. The method as claimed in claim 40 , where R6 is C1-C4-alkoxy-methyl.
54. The method as claimed in claim 40 , where R6 is C1-C4-alkyl which carries a hydroxyl substituent.
55. The method as claimed in claim 40 , where a is 0 or 1.
56. The method as claimed in claim 40 , where in case that a is 1, R2 is bound in β-position to the nitrogen ring atom carrying R1.
57. The method as claimed in claim 40 , where b is 0 or 1.
59. A method for treating disorders which respond to the modulation of the 5-HT2c receptor comprising administering to a subject in need thereof at least one compound selected from the group consisting of
8-(Trifluoromethyl)-2,3,4,6,7,8-hexahydro-1H-[1,4]diazepino[6,7,1-ij]quinoline;
(S)-8-(Trifluoromethyl)-2,3,4,6,7,8-hexahydro-1H-[1,4]diazepino[6,7,1-ij]quinoline;
(R)-8-(Trifluoromethyl)-2,3,4,6,7,8-hexahydro-1H-[1,4]diazepino[6,7,1-ij]quinoline;
8-(2,2,2-Trifluoroethyl)-2,3,4,6,7,8-hexahydro-1H-[1,4]diazepino[6,7,1-ij]quinoline;
(S)-8-(2,2,2-Trifluoroethyl)-2,3,4,6,7,8-hexahydro-1H-[1,4]diazepino[6,7,1-ij]quinoline;
(R)-8-(2,2,2-Trifluoroethyl)-2,3,4,6,7,8-hexahydro-1H-[1,4]diazepino[6,7,1-ij]quinoline;
8-(Difluoromethyl)-2,3,4,6,7,8-hexahydro-1H-[1,4]diazepino[6,7,1-ij]quinoline;
(S)-8-(Difluoromethyl)-2,3,4,6,7,8-hexahydro-1H-[1,4]diazepino[6,7,1-ij]quinoline;
(R)-8-(Difluoromethyl)-2,3,4,6,7,8-hexahydro-1H-[1,4]diazepino[6,7,1-ij]quinoline;
4-Methyl-8-(trifluoromethyl)-2,3,4,6,7,8-hexahydro-1H-[1,4]diazepino[6,7,1-ij]quinoline;
8-(Difluoromethyl)-4-methyl-2,3,4,6,7,8-hexahydro-1H-[1,4]diazepino[6,7,1-ij]quinoline;
(4-Methyl-2,3,4,6,7,8-hexahydro-1H-[1,4]diazepino[6,7,1-ij]quinolin-8-yl)methanol;
8-(Fluoromethyl)-4-methyl-2,3,4,6,7,8-hexahydro-1H-[1,4]diazepino[6,7,1-ij]quinoline;
8-(Ethoxymethyl)-4-methyl-2,3,4,6,7,8-hexahydro-1H-[1,4]diazepino[6,7,1-ij]quinoline; and
8-(Methoxymethyl)-4-methyl-2,3,4,6,7,8-hexahydro-1H-[1,4]diazepino[6,7,1-ij]quinoline;
and stereoisomers and pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof.
60. The method as claims in claim 59 , where the disorders are selected from the group consisting of damage of the central nervous system, disorders of the central nervous system, eating disorders, ocular hypertension, cardiovascular disorders, gastrointestinal disorders and diabetes.
61. The method as claims in claim 60 , where the disorders are selected from the group consisting of bipolar disorder, depression, atypical depression, mood episodes, adjustment disorders, anxiety, panic disorders, post-traumatic syndrome, psychoses, schizophrenia, cognitive deficits of schizophrenia, memory loss, dementia of aging, Alzheimer's disease, neuropsychiatric symptoms in Alzheimer's disease, behavioral disorders associated with dementia, social phobia, mental disorders in childhood, attention deficit hyperactivity disorder, organic mental disorders, autism, mutism, disruptive behavior disorder, impulse control disorder, borderline personality disorder, obsessive compulsive disorder, migraine and other conditions associated with cephalic pain or other pain, raised intracranial pressure, seizure disorders, epilepsy, substance use disorders, alcohol abuse, cocaine abuse, tobacco abuse, smoking cessation, sexual dysfunction/erectile dysfunction in males, sexual dysfunction in females, premenstrual syndrome, late luteal phase syndrome, chronic fatigue syndrome, sleep disorders, sleep apnoea, chronic fatigue syndrome, psoriasis, Parkinson's disease, psychosis in Parkinson's disease, neuropsychiatric symptoms in Parkinson's disease, Lewy Body dementia, neuropsychiatric symptoms in Lewy Body dementia, spinal cord injury, trauma, stroke, pain, bladder dysfunction/urinary incontinence, encephalitis, meningitis, eating disorders, obesity, bulimia, weight loss, anorexia nervosa, ocular hypertension, cardiovascular disorders, gastrointestinal disorders, diabetes insipidus, diabetes mellitus, type I diabetes, type II diabetes, type III diabetes, diabetes secondary to pancreatic diseases, diabetes related to steroid use, diabetes complications, hyperglycemia and insulin resistance.
62. The method as claimed in claim 61 , where the disorders are selected from the group consisting of schizophrenia, depression, bipolar disorders, obesity, substance use disorders, neuropsychiatric symptoms in Alzheimer's disease and neuropsychiatric symptoms in Parkinson's disease.
Priority Applications (1)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US15/397,902 US20170112851A1 (en) | 2014-03-14 | 2017-01-04 | Hexahydrodiazepinoquinolines carrying a substituted alkyl radical |
Applications Claiming Priority (3)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US201461953337P | 2014-03-14 | 2014-03-14 | |
US14/657,916 US9540376B2 (en) | 2014-03-14 | 2015-03-13 | Hexahydrodiazepinoquinolines carrying a substituted alkyl radical |
US15/397,902 US20170112851A1 (en) | 2014-03-14 | 2017-01-04 | Hexahydrodiazepinoquinolines carrying a substituted alkyl radical |
Related Parent Applications (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US14/657,916 Division US9540376B2 (en) | 2014-03-14 | 2015-03-13 | Hexahydrodiazepinoquinolines carrying a substituted alkyl radical |
Publications (1)
Publication Number | Publication Date |
---|---|
US20170112851A1 true US20170112851A1 (en) | 2017-04-27 |
Family
ID=52706154
Family Applications (2)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US14/657,916 Active US9540376B2 (en) | 2014-03-14 | 2015-03-13 | Hexahydrodiazepinoquinolines carrying a substituted alkyl radical |
US15/397,902 Abandoned US20170112851A1 (en) | 2014-03-14 | 2017-01-04 | Hexahydrodiazepinoquinolines carrying a substituted alkyl radical |
Family Applications Before (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US14/657,916 Active US9540376B2 (en) | 2014-03-14 | 2015-03-13 | Hexahydrodiazepinoquinolines carrying a substituted alkyl radical |
Country Status (3)
Country | Link |
---|---|
US (2) | US9540376B2 (en) |
EP (1) | EP3116874B1 (en) |
WO (1) | WO2015136091A1 (en) |
Family Cites Families (5)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
TWI312781B (en) | 2002-04-25 | 2009-08-01 | [1,4]diazepino[6,7,1-ij]quinoline derivatives as antipsychotic and antiobesity agents | |
US20080146583A1 (en) | 2003-05-15 | 2008-06-19 | Pfizer Inc | Treatment of Incontinence |
CN101410118A (en) | 2006-03-24 | 2009-04-15 | 惠氏公司 | Treatment of pain |
WO2007112073A2 (en) | 2006-03-24 | 2007-10-04 | Wyeth | Methods for modulating bladder function |
PE20150777A1 (en) | 2012-09-14 | 2015-06-20 | AbbVie Deutschland GmbH and Co KG | TRICYCLIC DERIVATIVES OF QUINOLINES AND QUINOXALINES |
-
2015
- 2015-03-13 US US14/657,916 patent/US9540376B2/en active Active
- 2015-03-13 EP EP15711464.6A patent/EP3116874B1/en not_active Not-in-force
- 2015-03-13 WO PCT/EP2015/055336 patent/WO2015136091A1/en active Application Filing
-
2017
- 2017-01-04 US US15/397,902 patent/US20170112851A1/en not_active Abandoned
Also Published As
Publication number | Publication date |
---|---|
US20150259346A1 (en) | 2015-09-17 |
US9540376B2 (en) | 2017-01-10 |
EP3116874B1 (en) | 2018-02-28 |
WO2015136091A1 (en) | 2015-09-17 |
EP3116874A1 (en) | 2017-01-18 |
Similar Documents
Publication | Publication Date | Title |
---|---|---|
JP6290217B2 (en) | Tricyclic quinoline and quinoxaline derivatives | |
SI9420058A (en) | Bicyclic aromatic compounds as therapeutic agents | |
US9573950B2 (en) | Substituted [1,4]diazepino[6,7,1-ij]quinolines as serotonin 5-HT2C receptor modulators | |
US20100056491A1 (en) | 4'-amino cyclic compounds having 5-ht6 receptor affinity | |
EP3143023B1 (en) | Oxindole compounds carrying a co-bound spiro substituent and use thereof for treating vasopressin-related diseases | |
EP3191459A1 (en) | Fused heterocyclic or carbocyclic compounds carrying a substituted cycloaliphatic radical and use thereof for treating vasopressin-related diseases | |
US20190048007A1 (en) | Tricyclic quinoline and quinoxaline derivatives | |
US9540376B2 (en) | Hexahydrodiazepinoquinolines carrying a substituted alkyl radical | |
US9688678B2 (en) | Oxindole compounds carrying a nitrogen-bound spiro substituent and use thereof for treating vasopressin-related diseases | |
JP2018095656A (en) | Tricyclic quinoline and quinoxaline derivative | |
US10160744B2 (en) | Quinoline compounds suitable for treating disorders that respond to the modulation of the serotonin 5-HT6 receptor | |
WO2018229197A1 (en) | Bicyclic heteroaromatic urea or carbamate compounds for use in therapy | |
US20200216434A1 (en) | Benzofuran ureas or carbamates and heteroaromatic analogues thereof for use in therapy |
Legal Events
Date | Code | Title | Description |
---|---|---|---|
AS | Assignment |
Owner name: ABBVIE DEUTSCHLAND GMBH & CO. KG, GERMANY Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNORS:BACKFISCH, GISELA;BAKKER, MARGARETHA HENRICA MARIA;BLAICH, GUNTER;AND OTHERS;SIGNING DATES FROM 20150326 TO 20150530;REEL/FRAME:040838/0572 |
|
STCB | Information on status: application discontinuation |
Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO RESPOND TO AN OFFICE ACTION |